xref: /linux/include/net/cfg80211.h (revision 2bd87951de659df3381ce083342aaf5b1ea24689)
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H
3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H
4 /*
5  * 802.11 device and configuration interface
6  *
7  * Copyright 2006-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018-2024 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #include <linux/ethtool.h>
14 #include <uapi/linux/rfkill.h>
15 #include <linux/netdevice.h>
16 #include <linux/debugfs.h>
17 #include <linux/list.h>
18 #include <linux/bug.h>
19 #include <linux/netlink.h>
20 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
21 #include <linux/nl80211.h>
22 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
23 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
24 #include <linux/net.h>
25 #include <linux/rfkill.h>
26 #include <net/regulatory.h>
27 
28 /**
29  * DOC: Introduction
30  *
31  * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges
32  * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated
33  * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used
34  * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent
35  * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers
36  * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely.
37  *
38  * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum
39  * use restrictions.
40  */
41 
42 
43 /**
44  * DOC: Device registration
45  *
46  * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device
47  * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs
48  * described below.
49  *
50  * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each
51  * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each
52  * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with
53  * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's
54  * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes
55  * the wireless part of the interface. Normally this struct is embedded in the
56  * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating
57  * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the
58  * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful.
59  *
60  * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has
61  * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and
62  * structures here describe these capabilities in detail.
63  */
64 
65 struct wiphy;
66 
67 /*
68  * wireless hardware capability structures
69  */
70 
71 /**
72  * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags
73  *
74  * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code.
75  *
76  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled.
77  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes
78  *	sending probe requests or beaconing.
79  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD: Power spectral density (in dBm) is set for this
80  *	channel.
81  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel.
82  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel
83  *	is not permitted.
84  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel
85  *	is not permitted.
86  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel.
87  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band,
88  *	this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this
89  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
90  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
91  *	restrictions.
92  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band,
93  *	this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this
94  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
95  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
96  *	restrictions.
97  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY
98  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
99  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
100  *	on this channel.
101  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
102  *	on this channel.
103  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel.
104  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted
105  *	on this channel.
106  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted
107  *	on this channel.
108  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted
109  *	on this channel.
110  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted
111  *	on this channel.
112  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted
113  *	on this channel.
114  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ: If the driver supports 320 MHz on the band,
115  *	this flag indicates that a 320 MHz channel cannot use this
116  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
117  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
118  *	restrictions.
119  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not permitted on this channel.
120  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DFS_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_RRF_DFS_CONCURRENT
121  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT: Client connection with VLP AP
122  *	not permitted using this channel
123  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT: Client connection with AFC AP
124  *	not permitted using this channel
125  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_CAN_MONITOR: This channel can be used for monitor
126  *	mode even in the presence of other (regulatory) restrictions,
127  *	even if it is otherwise disabled.
128  */
129 enum ieee80211_channel_flags {
130 	IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED		= 1<<0,
131 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR		= 1<<1,
132 	IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD		= 1<<2,
133 	IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR		= 1<<3,
134 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS	= 1<<4,
135 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS	= 1<<5,
136 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM		= 1<<6,
137 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ		= 1<<7,
138 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ	= 1<<8,
139 	IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY	= 1<<9,
140 	IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT	= 1<<10,
141 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ		= 1<<11,
142 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ		= 1<<12,
143 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE		= 1<<13,
144 	IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ		= 1<<14,
145 	IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ		= 1<<15,
146 	IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ		= 1<<16,
147 	IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ		= 1<<17,
148 	IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ		= 1<<18,
149 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ	= 1<<19,
150 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT		= 1<<20,
151 	IEEE80211_CHAN_DFS_CONCURRENT	= 1<<21,
152 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT = 1<<22,
153 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT = 1<<23,
154 	IEEE80211_CHAN_CAN_MONITOR	= 1<<24,
155 };
156 
157 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \
158 	(IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS)
159 
160 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS		60000
161 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS		(30 * 60 * 1000)
162 
163 /**
164  * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition
165  *
166  * This structure describes a single channel for use
167  * with cfg80211.
168  *
169  * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz
170  * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz
171  * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel
172  * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags.
173  * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory
174  *	code to support devices with additional restrictions
175  * @band: band this channel belongs to.
176  * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi
177  * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm)
178  * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm)
179  * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon
180  *	has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon()
181  *	to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band.
182  * @orig_mag: internal use
183  * @orig_mpwr: internal use
184  * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required
185  *	on this channel.
186  * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
187  * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels.
188  * @psd: power spectral density (in dBm)
189  */
190 struct ieee80211_channel {
191 	enum nl80211_band band;
192 	u32 center_freq;
193 	u16 freq_offset;
194 	u16 hw_value;
195 	u32 flags;
196 	int max_antenna_gain;
197 	int max_power;
198 	int max_reg_power;
199 	bool beacon_found;
200 	u32 orig_flags;
201 	int orig_mag, orig_mpwr;
202 	enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state;
203 	unsigned long dfs_state_entered;
204 	unsigned int dfs_cac_ms;
205 	s8 psd;
206 };
207 
208 /**
209  * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags
210  *
211  * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured
212  * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for
213  * different bands/PHY modes.
214  *
215  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short
216  *	preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and
217  *	with CCK rates.
218  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
219  *	when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the
220  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
221  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
222  *	when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
223  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
224  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
225  *	when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
226  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
227  * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode.
228  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode
229  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode
230  */
231 enum ieee80211_rate_flags {
232 	IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<0,
233 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A	= 1<<1,
234 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B	= 1<<2,
235 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G	= 1<<3,
236 	IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G		= 1<<4,
237 	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ	= 1<<5,
238 	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ	= 1<<6,
239 };
240 
241 /**
242  * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter
243  *
244  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS
245  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS
246  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS
247  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS
248  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type
249  */
250 enum ieee80211_bss_type {
251 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS,
252 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS,
253 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
254 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS,
255 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY
256 };
257 
258 /**
259  * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter
260  *
261  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set
262  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear
263  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting
264  */
265 enum ieee80211_privacy {
266 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON,
267 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF,
268 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY
269 };
270 
271 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x)	\
272 	((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF)
273 
274 /**
275  * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition
276  *
277  * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can
278  * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short
279  * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are
280  * passed around.
281  *
282  * @flags: rate-specific flags from &enum ieee80211_rate_flags
283  * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps
284  * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate
285  * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when
286  *	short preamble is used
287  */
288 struct ieee80211_rate {
289 	u32 flags;
290 	u16 bitrate;
291 	u16 hw_value, hw_value_short;
292 };
293 
294 /**
295  * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse
296  *
297  * @enable: is the feature enabled.
298  * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element.
299  * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset
300  * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use
301  * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use
302  * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by
303  *	members of the SRG
304  * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values
305  *	used by members of the SRG
306  */
307 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd {
308 	bool enable;
309 	u8 sr_ctrl;
310 	u8 non_srg_max_offset;
311 	u8 min_offset;
312 	u8 max_offset;
313 	u8 bss_color_bitmap[8];
314 	u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8];
315 };
316 
317 /**
318  * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring
319  *
320  * @color: the current color.
321  * @enabled: HE BSS color is used
322  * @partial: define the AID equation.
323  */
324 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color {
325 	u8 color;
326 	bool enabled;
327 	bool partial;
328 };
329 
330 /**
331  * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities
332  *
333  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
334  * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA.
335  *
336  * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA
337  * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec
338  * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor
339  * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing
340  * @mcs: Supported MCS rates
341  */
342 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap {
343 	u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */
344 	bool ht_supported;
345 	u8 ampdu_factor;
346 	u8 ampdu_density;
347 	struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs;
348 };
349 
350 /**
351  * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities
352  *
353  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
354  * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA.
355  *
356  * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA
357  * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec
358  * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates
359  */
360 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap {
361 	bool vht_supported;
362 	u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */
363 	struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs;
364 };
365 
366 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN		25
367 
368 /**
369  * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities
370  *
371  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
372  * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA.
373  *
374  * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid.
375  * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element.
376  * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
377  * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
378  */
379 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap {
380 	bool has_he;
381 	struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem;
382 	struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp;
383 	u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
384 };
385 
386 /**
387  * struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp - EHT max supported NSS per MCS
388  *
389  * See P802.11be_D1.3 Table 9-401k - "Subfields of the Supported EHT-MCS
390  * and NSS Set field"
391  *
392  * @only_20mhz: MCS/NSS support for 20 MHz-only STA.
393  * @bw: MCS/NSS support for 80, 160 and 320 MHz
394  * @bw._80: MCS/NSS support for BW <= 80 MHz
395  * @bw._160: MCS/NSS support for BW = 160 MHz
396  * @bw._320: MCS/NSS support for BW = 320 MHz
397  */
398 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp {
399 	union {
400 		struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_20mhz_only only_20mhz;
401 		struct {
402 			struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _80;
403 			struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _160;
404 			struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _320;
405 		} __packed bw;
406 	} __packed;
407 } __packed;
408 
409 #define IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN		32
410 
411 /**
412  * struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap - STA's EHT capabilities
413  *
414  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
415  * to describe 802.11be EHT capabilities for a STA.
416  *
417  * @has_eht: true iff EHT data is valid.
418  * @eht_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the eht capabilities element.
419  * @eht_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
420  * @eht_ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
421  */
422 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap {
423 	bool has_eht;
424 	struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem_fixed eht_cap_elem;
425 	struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp eht_mcs_nss_supp;
426 	u8 eht_ppe_thres[IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
427 };
428 
429 /* sparse defines __CHECKER__; see Documentation/dev-tools/sparse.rst */
430 #ifdef __CHECKER__
431 /*
432  * This is used to mark the sband->iftype_data pointer which is supposed
433  * to be an array with special access semantics (per iftype), but a lot
434  * of code got it wrong in the past, so with this marking sparse will be
435  * noisy when the pointer is used directly.
436  */
437 # define __iftd		__attribute__((noderef, address_space(__iftype_data)))
438 #else
439 # define __iftd
440 #endif /* __CHECKER__ */
441 
442 /**
443  * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data - sband data per interface type
444  *
445  * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the
446  * interface types defined in @types_mask.  Each type in the
447  * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data.
448  *
449  * @types_mask: interface types mask
450  * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities
451  * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a
452  *	6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value).
453  * @eht_cap: STA's EHT capabilities
454  * @vendor_elems: vendor element(s) to advertise
455  * @vendor_elems.data: vendor element(s) data
456  * @vendor_elems.len: vendor element(s) length
457  */
458 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data {
459 	u16 types_mask;
460 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
461 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
462 	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
463 	struct {
464 		const u8 *data;
465 		unsigned int len;
466 	} vendor_elems;
467 };
468 
469 /**
470  * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations
471  *
472  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz
473  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz
474  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz
475  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz
476  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
477  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
478  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz
479  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and
480  *	2.16GHz+2.16GHz
481  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
482  *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
483  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
484  *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
485  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
486  *	and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
487  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz,
488  *	2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
489  */
490 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config {
491 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4	= 4,
492 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5	= 5,
493 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6	= 6,
494 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7	= 7,
495 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8	= 8,
496 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9	= 9,
497 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10	= 10,
498 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11	= 11,
499 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12	= 12,
500 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13	= 13,
501 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14	= 14,
502 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15	= 15,
503 };
504 
505 /**
506  * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration
507  *
508  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
509  * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration
510  *
511  * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s)
512  *	that are allowed to be used for transmissions.
513  *	Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc.
514  *	Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported.
515  * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
516  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations
517  */
518 struct ieee80211_edmg {
519 	u8 channels;
520 	enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config;
521 };
522 
523 /**
524  * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities
525  *
526  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
527  * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA.
528  *
529  * @s1g: is STA an S1G STA
530  * @cap: S1G capabilities information
531  * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set
532  */
533 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap {
534 	bool s1g;
535 	u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */
536 	u8 nss_mcs[5];
537 };
538 
539 /**
540  * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition
541  *
542  * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy
543  * is able to operate in.
544  *
545  * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with
546  *	in this band.
547  * @band: the band this structure represents
548  * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels
549  * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with
550  *	in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported
551  *	rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM.
552  * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates
553  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band
554  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band
555  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band
556  * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band
557  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course)
558  * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries
559  * @iftype_data: interface type data entries.  Note that the bits in
560  *	@types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only
561  *	one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of
562  *	iftype_data).
563  */
564 struct ieee80211_supported_band {
565 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels;
566 	struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates;
567 	enum nl80211_band band;
568 	int n_channels;
569 	int n_bitrates;
570 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
571 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
572 	struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;
573 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap;
574 	u16 n_iftype_data;
575 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data __iftd *iftype_data;
576 };
577 
578 /**
579  * _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array
580  * @sband: the sband to initialize
581  * @iftd: the iftype data array pointer
582  * @n_iftd: the length of the iftype data array
583  *
584  * Set the sband iftype data array; use this where the length cannot
585  * be derived from the ARRAY_SIZE() of the argument, but prefer
586  * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data() where it can be used.
587  */
588 static inline void
589 _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
590 				 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftd,
591 				 u16 n_iftd)
592 {
593 	sband->iftype_data = (const void __iftd __force *)iftd;
594 	sband->n_iftype_data = n_iftd;
595 }
596 
597 /**
598  * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array
599  * @sband: the sband to initialize
600  * @iftd: the iftype data array
601  */
602 #define ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd)	\
603 	_ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd, ARRAY_SIZE(iftd))
604 
605 /**
606  * for_each_sband_iftype_data - iterate sband iftype data entries
607  * @sband: the sband whose iftype_data array to iterate
608  * @i: iterator counter
609  * @iftd: iftype data pointer to set
610  */
611 #define for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, iftd)				\
612 	for (i = 0, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i];	\
613 	     i < (sband)->n_iftype_data;					\
614 	     i++, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i])
615 
616 /**
617  * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype
618  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
619  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
620  *
621  * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found
622  */
623 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *
624 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
625 				u8 iftype)
626 {
627 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data;
628 	int i;
629 
630 	if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX))
631 		return NULL;
632 
633 	if (iftype == NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN)
634 		iftype = NL80211_IFTYPE_AP;
635 
636 	for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, data) {
637 		if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype))
638 			return data;
639 	}
640 
641 	return NULL;
642 }
643 
644 /**
645  * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype
646  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
647  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
648  *
649  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found
650  */
651 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
652 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
653 			    u8 iftype)
654 {
655 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
656 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
657 
658 	if (data && data->he_cap.has_he)
659 		return &data->he_cap;
660 
661 	return NULL;
662 }
663 
664 /**
665  * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
666  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
667  * @iftype: the iftype to search for
668  *
669  * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
670  */
671 static inline __le16
672 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
673 			   enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
674 {
675 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
676 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
677 
678 	if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he))
679 		return 0;
680 
681 	return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa;
682 }
683 
684 /**
685  * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap - return ETH capabilities for an sband's iftype
686  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
687  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
688  *
689  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or NULL is none found
690  */
691 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
692 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
693 			     enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
694 {
695 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
696 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
697 
698 	if (data && data->eht_cap.has_eht)
699 		return &data->eht_cap;
700 
701 	return NULL;
702 }
703 
704 /**
705  * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree
706  *
707  * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for
708  *
709  * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful
710  * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board
711  * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier).
712  *
713  * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable
714  * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with
715  * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make
716  * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified
717  * without affecting other devices.
718  *
719  * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev.
720  * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first.
721  * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register().
722  */
723 #ifdef CONFIG_OF
724 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy);
725 #else /* CONFIG_OF */
726 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy)
727 {
728 }
729 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */
730 
731 
732 /*
733  * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods
734  */
735 
736 /**
737  * DOC: Actions and configuration
738  *
739  * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration
740  * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these
741  * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these
742  * operations use are described separately.
743  *
744  * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status
745  * information via some functions that drivers need to call.
746  *
747  * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described
748  * in a separate chapter.
749  */
750 
751 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\
752 				    WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN)
753 
754 /**
755  * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters
756  * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise
757  *	%MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set
758  * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames
759  * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface.
760  *	If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may
761  *	determine the address as needed.
762  *	This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the
763  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag.  Others may support creating
764  **	only p2p devices with specified MAC.
765  * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets
766  *	belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed
767  * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring
768  *	MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed
769  */
770 struct vif_params {
771 	u32 flags;
772 	int use_4addr;
773 	u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN];
774 	const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups;
775 	const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr;
776 };
777 
778 /**
779  * struct key_params - key information
780  *
781  * Information about a key
782  *
783  * @key: key material
784  * @key_len: length of key material
785  * @cipher: cipher suite selector
786  * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used
787  *	with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian,
788  *	length given by @seq_len.
789  * @seq_len: length of @seq.
790  * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero)
791  * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX)
792  */
793 struct key_params {
794 	const u8 *key;
795 	const u8 *seq;
796 	int key_len;
797 	int seq_len;
798 	u16 vlan_id;
799 	u32 cipher;
800 	enum nl80211_key_mode mode;
801 };
802 
803 /**
804  * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition
805  * @chan: the (control) channel
806  * @width: channel width
807  * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment
808  * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment
809  *	(only with 80+80 MHz)
810  * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration.
811  *	If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero),
812  *	chan will define the primary channel and all other
813  *	parameters are ignored.
814  * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz
815  * @punctured: mask of the punctured 20 MHz subchannels, with
816  *	bits turned on being disabled (punctured); numbered
817  *	from lower to higher frequency (like in the spec)
818  */
819 struct cfg80211_chan_def {
820 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
821 	enum nl80211_chan_width width;
822 	u32 center_freq1;
823 	u32 center_freq2;
824 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
825 	u16 freq1_offset;
826 	u16 punctured;
827 };
828 
829 /*
830  * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control
831  */
832 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask {
833 	struct {
834 		u32 legacy;
835 		u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN];
836 		u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
837 		u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
838 		enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi;
839 		enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi;
840 		enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf;
841 	} control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
842 };
843 
844 
845 /**
846  * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration
847  * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration
848  *	of the peer.
849  * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify
850  * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed,
851  *	similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp.
852  * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID
853  * @retry_long: retry count value
854  * @retry_short: retry count value
855  * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
856  * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS
857  * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
858  * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type
859  * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID
860  */
861 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg {
862 	bool config_override;
863 	u8 tids;
864 	u64 mask;
865 	enum nl80211_tid_config noack;
866 	u8 retry_long, retry_short;
867 	enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu;
868 	enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts;
869 	enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu;
870 	enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type;
871 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask;
872 };
873 
874 /**
875  * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration
876  * @peer: Station's MAC address
877  * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied
878  * @tid_conf: Configuration change info
879  */
880 struct cfg80211_tid_config {
881 	const u8 *peer;
882 	u32 n_tid_conf;
883 	struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[] __counted_by(n_tid_conf);
884 };
885 
886 /**
887  * struct cfg80211_fils_aad - FILS AAD data
888  * @macaddr: STA MAC address
889  * @kek: FILS KEK
890  * @kek_len: FILS KEK length
891  * @snonce: STA Nonce
892  * @anonce: AP Nonce
893  */
894 struct cfg80211_fils_aad {
895 	const u8 *macaddr;
896 	const u8 *kek;
897 	u8 kek_len;
898 	const u8 *snonce;
899 	const u8 *anonce;
900 };
901 
902 /**
903  * struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp - enable/disable HW timestamping
904  * @macaddr: peer MAC address. NULL to enable/disable HW timestamping for all
905  *	addresses.
906  * @enable: if set, enable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address.
907  *	Otherwise disable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address.
908  */
909 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp {
910 	const u8 *macaddr;
911 	bool enable;
912 };
913 
914 /**
915  * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef
916  * @chandef: the channel definition
917  *
918  * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given
919  * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion.
920  */
921 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type
922 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
923 {
924 	switch (chandef->width) {
925 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
926 		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
927 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
928 		return NL80211_CHAN_HT20;
929 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
930 		if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq)
931 			return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS;
932 		return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS;
933 	default:
934 		WARN_ON(1);
935 		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
936 	}
937 }
938 
939 /**
940  * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type
941  * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill
942  * @channel: the control channel
943  * @chantype: the channel type
944  *
945  * Given a channel type, create a channel definition.
946  */
947 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
948 			     struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
949 			     enum nl80211_channel_type chantype);
950 
951 /**
952  * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical
953  * @chandef1: first channel definition
954  * @chandef2: second channel definition
955  *
956  * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are
957  * identical, %false otherwise.
958  */
959 static inline bool
960 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
961 			   const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2)
962 {
963 	return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan &&
964 		chandef1->width == chandef2->width &&
965 		chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 &&
966 		chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset &&
967 		chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2 &&
968 		chandef1->punctured == chandef2->punctured);
969 }
970 
971 /**
972  * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel
973  *
974  * @chandef: the channel definition
975  *
976  * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise.
977  */
978 static inline bool
979 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
980 {
981 	return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config;
982 }
983 
984 /**
985  * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible
986  * @chandef1: first channel definition
987  * @chandef2: second channel definition
988  *
989  * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible,
990  * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise.
991  */
992 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *
993 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
994 			    const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2);
995 
996 /**
997  * nl80211_chan_width_to_mhz - get the channel width in MHz
998  * @chan_width: the channel width from &enum nl80211_chan_width
999  *
1000  * Return: channel width in MHz if the chan_width from &enum nl80211_chan_width
1001  * is valid. -1 otherwise.
1002  */
1003 int nl80211_chan_width_to_mhz(enum nl80211_chan_width chan_width);
1004 
1005 /**
1006  * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid
1007  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1008  * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise.
1009  */
1010 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1011 
1012 /**
1013  * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used
1014  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1015  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1016  * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set
1017  * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise.
1018  */
1019 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1020 			     const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1021 			     u32 prohibited_flags);
1022 
1023 /**
1024  * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required
1025  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1026  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1027  * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype
1028  * Returns:
1029  *	1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error
1030  */
1031 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1032 				  const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1033 				  enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
1034 
1035 /**
1036  * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable - checks if chandef is DFS usable and we
1037  *				 can/need start CAC on such channel
1038  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1039  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1040  *
1041  * Return: true if all channels available and at least
1042  *	   one channel requires CAC (NL80211_DFS_USABLE)
1043  */
1044 bool cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1045 				 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1046 
1047 /**
1048  * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time - get the DFS CAC time (in ms) for given
1049  *				   channel definition
1050  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1051  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1052  *
1053  * Returns: DFS CAC time (in ms) which applies for this channel definition
1054  */
1055 unsigned int
1056 cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1057 			      const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1058 
1059 /**
1060  * cfg80211_chandef_primary - calculate primary 40/80/160 MHz freq
1061  * @chandef: chandef to calculate for
1062  * @primary_chan_width: primary channel width to calculate center for
1063  * @punctured: punctured sub-channel bitmap, will be recalculated
1064  *	according to the new bandwidth, can be %NULL
1065  *
1066  * Returns: the primary 40/80/160 MHz channel center frequency, or -1
1067  *	for errors, updating the punctured bitmap
1068  */
1069 int cfg80211_chandef_primary(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1070 			     enum nl80211_chan_width primary_chan_width,
1071 			     u16 *punctured);
1072 
1073 /**
1074  * nl80211_send_chandef - sends the channel definition.
1075  * @msg: the msg to send channel definition
1076  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1077  *
1078  * Returns: 0 if sent the channel definition to msg, < 0 on error
1079  **/
1080 int nl80211_send_chandef(struct sk_buff *msg, const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1081 
1082 /**
1083  * ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags - return rate flags for channel width
1084  * @width: the channel width of the channel
1085  *
1086  * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK
1087  * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels.
1088  *
1089  * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel width
1090  */
1091 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
1092 ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(enum nl80211_chan_width width)
1093 {
1094 	switch (width) {
1095 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
1096 		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ;
1097 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
1098 		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ;
1099 	default:
1100 		break;
1101 	}
1102 	return 0;
1103 }
1104 
1105 /**
1106  * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel
1107  * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
1108  *
1109  * See ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags().
1110  *
1111  * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel
1112  */
1113 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
1114 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
1115 {
1116 	return ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(chandef->width);
1117 }
1118 
1119 /**
1120  * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef
1121  *
1122  * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel
1123  * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual
1124  * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels.
1125  *
1126  * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
1127  *
1128  * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef
1129  */
1130 static inline int
1131 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
1132 {
1133 	switch (chandef->width) {
1134 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
1135 		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6,
1136 			   chandef->chan->max_power);
1137 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
1138 		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3,
1139 			   chandef->chan->max_power);
1140 	default:
1141 		break;
1142 	}
1143 	return chandef->chan->max_power;
1144 }
1145 
1146 /**
1147  * cfg80211_any_usable_channels - check for usable channels
1148  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check for
1149  * @band_mask: which bands to check on
1150  * @prohibited_flags: which channels to not consider usable,
1151  *	%IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED is always taken into account
1152  *
1153  * Return: %true if usable channels found, %false otherwise
1154  */
1155 bool cfg80211_any_usable_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1156 				  unsigned long band_mask,
1157 				  u32 prohibited_flags);
1158 
1159 /**
1160  * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags
1161  *
1162  * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in
1163  * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
1164  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in
1165  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in
1166  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in
1167  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in
1168  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in
1169  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in
1170  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in
1171  *
1172  * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info
1173  * it has filled in during the get_survey().
1174  */
1175 enum survey_info_flags {
1176 	SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM		= BIT(0),
1177 	SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE		= BIT(1),
1178 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME		= BIT(2),
1179 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY		= BIT(3),
1180 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY	= BIT(4),
1181 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX		= BIT(5),
1182 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX		= BIT(6),
1183 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN		= BIT(7),
1184 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX		= BIT(8),
1185 };
1186 
1187 /**
1188  * struct survey_info - channel survey response
1189  *
1190  * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single
1191  *	record to report global statistics
1192  * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags
1193  * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are
1194  *	optional
1195  * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel)
1196  * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy
1197  * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy
1198  * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data
1199  * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data
1200  * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning
1201  * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS
1202  *
1203  * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information.
1204  *
1205  * This structure can later be expanded with things like
1206  * channel duty cycle etc.
1207  */
1208 struct survey_info {
1209 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
1210 	u64 time;
1211 	u64 time_busy;
1212 	u64 time_ext_busy;
1213 	u64 time_rx;
1214 	u64 time_tx;
1215 	u64 time_scan;
1216 	u64 time_bss_rx;
1217 	u32 filled;
1218 	s8 noise;
1219 };
1220 
1221 #define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES	10
1222 
1223 /**
1224  * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings
1225  * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled
1226  *	(from enum nl80211_wpa_versions)
1227  * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset)
1228  * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers
1229  * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites
1230  * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites
1231  * @akm_suites: AKM suites
1232  * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
1233  *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
1234  *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
1235  *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
1236  * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be
1237  *	allowed through even on unauthorized ports
1238  * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port
1239  *	protocol frames.
1240  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
1241  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
1242  * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control
1243  *	port for mac80211
1244  * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload)
1245  * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE
1246  *	offload)
1247  * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload)
1248  * @sae_pwe: The mechanisms allowed for SAE PWE derivation:
1249  *
1250  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED
1251  *	  Not-specified, used to indicate userspace did not specify any
1252  *	  preference. The driver should follow its internal policy in
1253  *	  such a scenario.
1254  *
1255  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK
1256  *	  Allow hunting-and-pecking loop only
1257  *
1258  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT
1259  *	  Allow hash-to-element only
1260  *
1261  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH
1262  *	  Allow either hunting-and-pecking loop or hash-to-element
1263  */
1264 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings {
1265 	u32 wpa_versions;
1266 	u32 cipher_group;
1267 	int n_ciphers_pairwise;
1268 	u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES];
1269 	int n_akm_suites;
1270 	u32 akm_suites[CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES];
1271 	bool control_port;
1272 	__be16 control_port_ethertype;
1273 	bool control_port_no_encrypt;
1274 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
1275 	bool control_port_no_preauth;
1276 	const u8 *psk;
1277 	const u8 *sae_pwd;
1278 	u8 sae_pwd_len;
1279 	enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism sae_pwe;
1280 };
1281 
1282 /**
1283  * struct cfg80211_mbssid_config - AP settings for multi bssid
1284  *
1285  * @tx_wdev: pointer to the transmitted interface in the MBSSID set
1286  * @index: index of this AP in the multi bssid group.
1287  * @ema: set to true if the beacons should be sent out in EMA mode.
1288  */
1289 struct cfg80211_mbssid_config {
1290 	struct wireless_dev *tx_wdev;
1291 	u8 index;
1292 	bool ema;
1293 };
1294 
1295 /**
1296  * struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems - Multiple BSSID elements
1297  *
1298  * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems.
1299  *
1300  * @elem: Array of multiple BSSID element(s) to be added into Beacon frames.
1301  * @elem.data: Data for multiple BSSID elements.
1302  * @elem.len: Length of data.
1303  */
1304 struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems {
1305 	u8 cnt;
1306 	struct {
1307 		const u8 *data;
1308 		size_t len;
1309 	} elem[] __counted_by(cnt);
1310 };
1311 
1312 /**
1313  * struct cfg80211_rnr_elems - Reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements
1314  *
1315  * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems.
1316  *
1317  * @elem: Array of RNR element(s) to be added into Beacon frames.
1318  * @elem.data: Data for RNR elements.
1319  * @elem.len: Length of data.
1320  */
1321 struct cfg80211_rnr_elems {
1322 	u8 cnt;
1323 	struct {
1324 		const u8 *data;
1325 		size_t len;
1326 	} elem[] __counted_by(cnt);
1327 };
1328 
1329 /**
1330  * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data
1331  * @link_id: the link ID for the AP MLD link sending this beacon
1332  * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE)
1333  *	or %NULL if not changed
1334  * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE)
1335  *	or %NULL if not changed
1336  * @head_len: length of @head
1337  * @tail_len: length of @tail
1338  * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL
1339  * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets
1340  * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response
1341  *	frames or %NULL
1342  * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets
1343  * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association
1344  *	Response frames or %NULL
1345  * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets
1346  * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp)
1347  * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only)
1348  * @mbssid_ies: multiple BSSID elements
1349  * @rnr_ies: reduced neighbor report elements
1350  * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change
1351  *	(which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data)
1352  * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token
1353  *	(measurement type 8)
1354  * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement
1355  *	Token (measurement type 11)
1356  * @lci_len: LCI data length
1357  * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length
1358  * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings
1359  * @he_bss_color_valid: indicates whether bss color
1360  *	attribute is present in beacon data or not.
1361  */
1362 struct cfg80211_beacon_data {
1363 	unsigned int link_id;
1364 
1365 	const u8 *head, *tail;
1366 	const u8 *beacon_ies;
1367 	const u8 *proberesp_ies;
1368 	const u8 *assocresp_ies;
1369 	const u8 *probe_resp;
1370 	const u8 *lci;
1371 	const u8 *civicloc;
1372 	struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems *mbssid_ies;
1373 	struct cfg80211_rnr_elems *rnr_ies;
1374 	s8 ftm_responder;
1375 
1376 	size_t head_len, tail_len;
1377 	size_t beacon_ies_len;
1378 	size_t proberesp_ies_len;
1379 	size_t assocresp_ies_len;
1380 	size_t probe_resp_len;
1381 	size_t lci_len;
1382 	size_t civicloc_len;
1383 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
1384 	bool he_bss_color_valid;
1385 };
1386 
1387 struct mac_address {
1388 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
1389 };
1390 
1391 /**
1392  * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data
1393  *
1394  * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's
1395  *	entry specified by mac_addr
1396  * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed
1397  * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL
1398  */
1399 struct cfg80211_acl_data {
1400 	enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy;
1401 	int n_acl_entries;
1402 
1403 	/* Keep it last */
1404 	struct mac_address mac_addrs[] __counted_by(n_acl_entries);
1405 };
1406 
1407 /**
1408  * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
1409  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
1410  *
1411  * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated.
1412  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1413  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1414  * @tmpl_len: Template length
1415  * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action
1416  *	frame headers.
1417  */
1418 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery {
1419 	bool update;
1420 	u32 min_interval;
1421 	u32 max_interval;
1422 	size_t tmpl_len;
1423 	const u8 *tmpl;
1424 };
1425 
1426 /**
1427  * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe
1428  *	response parameters in 6GHz.
1429  *
1430  * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated.
1431  * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned
1432  *	in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive
1433  *	scanning
1434  * @tmpl_len: Template length
1435  * @tmpl: Template data for probe response
1436  */
1437 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp {
1438 	bool update;
1439 	u32 interval;
1440 	size_t tmpl_len;
1441 	const u8 *tmpl;
1442 };
1443 
1444 /**
1445  * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration
1446  *
1447  * Used to configure an AP interface.
1448  *
1449  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
1450  * @beacon: beacon data
1451  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1452  * @dtim_period: DTIM period
1453  * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from
1454  *	user space)
1455  * @ssid_len: length of @ssid
1456  * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames
1457  * @crypto: crypto settings
1458  * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy
1459  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
1460  * @smps_mode: SMPS mode
1461  * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity.
1462  * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window
1463  * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS
1464  * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for
1465  *	MAC address based access control
1466  * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG
1467  *	networks.
1468  * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
1469  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled)
1470  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled)
1471  * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1472  * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled)
1473  * @eht_oper: EHT operation IE (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled)
1474  * @ht_required: stations must support HT
1475  * @vht_required: stations must support VHT
1476  * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time
1477  * @he_required: stations must support HE
1478  * @sae_h2e_required: stations must support direct H2E technique in SAE
1479  * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags
1480  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings
1481  * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1482  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1483  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1484  * @mbssid_config: AP settings for multiple bssid
1485  */
1486 struct cfg80211_ap_settings {
1487 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1488 
1489 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1490 
1491 	int beacon_interval, dtim_period;
1492 	const u8 *ssid;
1493 	size_t ssid_len;
1494 	enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid;
1495 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
1496 	bool privacy;
1497 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
1498 	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1499 	int inactivity_timeout;
1500 	u8 p2p_ctwindow;
1501 	bool p2p_opp_ps;
1502 	const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl;
1503 	bool pbss;
1504 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
1505 
1506 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap;
1507 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap;
1508 	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap;
1509 	const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper;
1510 	const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_cap;
1511 	const struct ieee80211_eht_operation *eht_oper;
1512 	bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required, sae_h2e_required;
1513 	bool twt_responder;
1514 	u32 flags;
1515 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
1516 	struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1517 	struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1518 	struct cfg80211_mbssid_config mbssid_config;
1519 };
1520 
1521 
1522 /**
1523  * struct cfg80211_ap_update - AP configuration update
1524  *
1525  * Subset of &struct cfg80211_ap_settings, for updating a running AP.
1526  *
1527  * @beacon: beacon data
1528  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1529  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1530  */
1531 struct cfg80211_ap_update {
1532 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1533 	struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1534 	struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1535 };
1536 
1537 /**
1538  * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings
1539  *
1540  * Used for channel switch
1541  *
1542  * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch
1543  * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch
1544  * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1545  * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1546  * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail)
1547  * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response
1548  * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel
1549  * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel
1550  * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing
1551  * @count: number of beacons until switch
1552  * @link_id: defines the link on which channel switch is expected during
1553  *	MLO. 0 in case of non-MLO.
1554  */
1555 struct cfg80211_csa_settings {
1556 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1557 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa;
1558 	const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon;
1559 	const u16 *counter_offsets_presp;
1560 	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon;
1561 	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp;
1562 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after;
1563 	bool radar_required;
1564 	bool block_tx;
1565 	u8 count;
1566 	u8 link_id;
1567 };
1568 
1569 /**
1570  * struct cfg80211_color_change_settings - color change settings
1571  *
1572  * Used for bss color change
1573  *
1574  * @beacon_color_change: beacon data while performing the color countdown
1575  * @counter_offset_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1576  * @counter_offset_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1577  * @beacon_next: beacon data to be used after the color change
1578  * @count: number of beacons until the color change
1579  * @color: the color used after the change
1580  */
1581 struct cfg80211_color_change_settings {
1582 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_color_change;
1583 	u16 counter_offset_beacon;
1584 	u16 counter_offset_presp;
1585 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_next;
1586 	u8 count;
1587 	u8 color;
1588 };
1589 
1590 /**
1591  * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations
1592  *
1593  * Used to pass interface combination parameters
1594  *
1595  * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want
1596  *	to use for verification
1597  * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel
1598  *	width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of
1599  *	&struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths
1600  * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface
1601  *	type.  The index is the interface type as specified in &enum
1602  *	nl80211_iftype.
1603  * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface
1604  *	that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of
1605  *	the verification
1606  */
1607 struct iface_combination_params {
1608 	int num_different_channels;
1609 	u8 radar_detect;
1610 	int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES];
1611 	u32 new_beacon_int;
1612 };
1613 
1614 /**
1615  * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply
1616  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp)
1617  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability
1618  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state
1619  *
1620  * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling,
1621  * for those that don't these flags will are used.
1622  */
1623 enum station_parameters_apply_mask {
1624 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0),
1625 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1),
1626 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2),
1627 };
1628 
1629 /**
1630  * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
1631  *
1632  * Used to configure txpower for station.
1633  *
1634  * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power
1635  *	is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be
1636  *	overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx
1637  *	power per-interface or per-station.
1638  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
1639  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
1640  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
1641  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
1642  *	per peer TPC.
1643  */
1644 struct sta_txpwr {
1645 	s16 power;
1646 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
1647 };
1648 
1649 /**
1650  * struct link_station_parameters - link station parameters
1651  *
1652  * Used to change and create a new link station.
1653  *
1654  * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station
1655  * @link_id: the link id (-1 for non-MLD station)
1656  * @link_mac: MAC address of the link
1657  * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1658  *	(or NULL for no change)
1659  * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates
1660  * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station
1661  * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station
1662  * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification
1663  * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used
1664  * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station
1665  * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities
1666  * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station
1667  * @txpwr_set: txpwr field is set
1668  * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station
1669  * @eht_capa: EHT capabilities of station
1670  * @eht_capa_len: the length of the EHT capabilities
1671  */
1672 struct link_station_parameters {
1673 	const u8 *mld_mac;
1674 	int link_id;
1675 	const u8 *link_mac;
1676 	const u8 *supported_rates;
1677 	u8 supported_rates_len;
1678 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa;
1679 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa;
1680 	u8 opmode_notif;
1681 	bool opmode_notif_used;
1682 	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa;
1683 	u8 he_capa_len;
1684 	struct sta_txpwr txpwr;
1685 	bool txpwr_set;
1686 	const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa;
1687 	const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_capa;
1688 	u8 eht_capa_len;
1689 };
1690 
1691 /**
1692  * struct link_station_del_parameters - link station deletion parameters
1693  *
1694  * Used to delete a link station entry (or all stations).
1695  *
1696  * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station
1697  * @link_id: the link id
1698  */
1699 struct link_station_del_parameters {
1700 	const u8 *mld_mac;
1701 	u32 link_id;
1702 };
1703 
1704 /**
1705  * struct cfg80211_ttlm_params: TID to link mapping parameters
1706  *
1707  * Used for setting a TID to link mapping.
1708  *
1709  * @dlink: Downlink TID to link mapping, as defined in section 9.4.2.314
1710  *     (TID-To-Link Mapping element) in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
1711  * @ulink: Uplink TID to link mapping, as defined in section 9.4.2.314
1712  *     (TID-To-Link Mapping element) in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
1713  */
1714 struct cfg80211_ttlm_params {
1715 	u16 dlink[8];
1716 	u16 ulink[8];
1717 };
1718 
1719 /**
1720  * struct station_parameters - station parameters
1721  *
1722  * Used to change and create a new station.
1723  *
1724  * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to
1725  * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed
1726  *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1727  * @sta_flags_set: station flags values
1728  *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1729  * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change
1730  * @aid: AID or zero for no change
1731  * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero)
1732  * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change
1733  * @plink_action: plink action to take
1734  * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station
1735  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format
1736  *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
1737  * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the
1738  *	QoS info field (but already shifted down)
1739  * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed
1740  *	(for those that don't have a natural "no change" value),
1741  *	see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask
1742  * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set
1743  *	to unknown)
1744  * @capability: station capability
1745  * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station
1746  * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities
1747  * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format
1748  * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels
1749  * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format
1750  * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes
1751  * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism
1752  * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station
1753  * @link_sta_params: link related params.
1754  */
1755 struct station_parameters {
1756 	struct net_device *vlan;
1757 	u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set;
1758 	u32 sta_modify_mask;
1759 	int listen_interval;
1760 	u16 aid;
1761 	u16 vlan_id;
1762 	u16 peer_aid;
1763 	u8 plink_action;
1764 	u8 plink_state;
1765 	u8 uapsd_queues;
1766 	u8 max_sp;
1767 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1768 	u16 capability;
1769 	const u8 *ext_capab;
1770 	u8 ext_capab_len;
1771 	const u8 *supported_channels;
1772 	u8 supported_channels_len;
1773 	const u8 *supported_oper_classes;
1774 	u8 supported_oper_classes_len;
1775 	int support_p2p_ps;
1776 	u16 airtime_weight;
1777 	struct link_station_parameters link_sta_params;
1778 };
1779 
1780 /**
1781  * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters
1782  *
1783  * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations).
1784  *
1785  * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations
1786  * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal
1787  *	(10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication)
1788  * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame
1789  * @link_id: Link ID indicating a link that stations to be flushed must be
1790  *	using; valid only for MLO, but can also be -1 for MLO to really
1791  *	remove all stations.
1792  */
1793 struct station_del_parameters {
1794 	const u8 *mac;
1795 	u8 subtype;
1796 	u16 reason_code;
1797 	int link_id;
1798 };
1799 
1800 /**
1801  * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified
1802  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface
1803  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still
1804  *	unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted)
1805  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has
1806  *	the AP MLME in the device
1807  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface
1808  * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station
1809  * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry
1810  *	while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when
1811  *	being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is
1812  *	supported/used)
1813  * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active
1814  *	entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace)
1815  * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed)
1816  * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed)
1817  */
1818 enum cfg80211_station_type {
1819 	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT,
1820 	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC,
1821 	CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT,
1822 	CFG80211_STA_AP_STA,
1823 	CFG80211_STA_IBSS,
1824 	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP,
1825 	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE,
1826 	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL,
1827 	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER,
1828 };
1829 
1830 /**
1831  * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes
1832  * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on
1833  * @params: the new parameters for a station
1834  * @statype: the type of station being modified
1835  *
1836  * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function
1837  * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that
1838  * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable.
1839  *
1840  * Return: 0 if the change is acceptable, otherwise an error code. Note that
1841  * it may modify the parameters for backward compatibility reasons, so don't
1842  * use them before calling this.
1843  */
1844 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1845 				  struct station_parameters *params,
1846 				  enum cfg80211_station_type statype);
1847 
1848 /**
1849  * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags
1850  *
1851  * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1852  * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1853  *
1854  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS
1855  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS
1856  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
1857  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS
1858  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information
1859  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode
1860  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG: 60GHz extended SC MCS
1861  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS information
1862  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS: MCS field filled with S1G MCS
1863  */
1864 enum rate_info_flags {
1865 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS			= BIT(0),
1866 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS			= BIT(1),
1867 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1868 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG			= BIT(3),
1869 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS			= BIT(4),
1870 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG			= BIT(5),
1871 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG		= BIT(6),
1872 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS			= BIT(7),
1873 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS			= BIT(8),
1874 };
1875 
1876 /**
1877  * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information
1878  *
1879  * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth.
1880  *
1881  * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth
1882  * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth
1883  * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth
1884  * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth
1885  * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth
1886  * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth
1887  * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation
1888  * @RATE_INFO_BW_320: 320 MHz bandwidth
1889  * @RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU: bandwidth determined by EHT RU allocation
1890  * @RATE_INFO_BW_1: 1 MHz bandwidth
1891  * @RATE_INFO_BW_2: 2 MHz bandwidth
1892  * @RATE_INFO_BW_4: 4 MHz bandwidth
1893  * @RATE_INFO_BW_8: 8 MHz bandwidth
1894  * @RATE_INFO_BW_16: 16 MHz bandwidth
1895  */
1896 enum rate_info_bw {
1897 	RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0,
1898 	RATE_INFO_BW_5,
1899 	RATE_INFO_BW_10,
1900 	RATE_INFO_BW_40,
1901 	RATE_INFO_BW_80,
1902 	RATE_INFO_BW_160,
1903 	RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU,
1904 	RATE_INFO_BW_320,
1905 	RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU,
1906 	RATE_INFO_BW_1,
1907 	RATE_INFO_BW_2,
1908 	RATE_INFO_BW_4,
1909 	RATE_INFO_BW_8,
1910 	RATE_INFO_BW_16,
1911 };
1912 
1913 /**
1914  * struct rate_info - bitrate information
1915  *
1916  * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate
1917  *
1918  * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags
1919  * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg
1920  * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE/EHT/S1G rate
1921  * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only)
1922  * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw)
1923  * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi)
1924  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1925  * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc,
1926  *	only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU)
1927  * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4)
1928  * @eht_gi: EHT guard interval (from &enum nl80211_eht_gi)
1929  * @eht_ru_alloc: EHT RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc,
1930  *	only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU)
1931  */
1932 struct rate_info {
1933 	u16 flags;
1934 	u16 legacy;
1935 	u8 mcs;
1936 	u8 nss;
1937 	u8 bw;
1938 	u8 he_gi;
1939 	u8 he_dcm;
1940 	u8 he_ru_alloc;
1941 	u8 n_bonded_ch;
1942 	u8 eht_gi;
1943 	u8 eht_ru_alloc;
1944 };
1945 
1946 /**
1947  * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags
1948  *
1949  * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1950  * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1951  *
1952  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled
1953  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1954  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled
1955  */
1956 enum bss_param_flags {
1957 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT	= 1<<0,
1958 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<1,
1959 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME	= 1<<2,
1960 };
1961 
1962 /**
1963  * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station
1964  *
1965  * Information about the currently associated BSS
1966  *
1967  * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags
1968  * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS
1969  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1970  */
1971 struct sta_bss_parameters {
1972 	u8 flags;
1973 	u8 dtim_period;
1974 	u16 beacon_interval;
1975 };
1976 
1977 /**
1978  * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID
1979  * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to
1980  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1981  * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged
1982  * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged
1983  * @flows: number of new flows seen
1984  * @drops: total number of packets dropped
1985  * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE
1986  * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow
1987  * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
1988  * @collisions: number of hash collisions
1989  * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued
1990  * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued
1991  * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported
1992  */
1993 struct cfg80211_txq_stats {
1994 	u32 filled;
1995 	u32 backlog_bytes;
1996 	u32 backlog_packets;
1997 	u32 flows;
1998 	u32 drops;
1999 	u32 ecn_marks;
2000 	u32 overlimit;
2001 	u32 overmemory;
2002 	u32 collisions;
2003 	u32 tx_bytes;
2004 	u32 tx_packets;
2005 	u32 max_flows;
2006 };
2007 
2008 /**
2009  * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics
2010  * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to
2011  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
2012  * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs
2013  * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs
2014  * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for
2015  *	transmitted MSDUs
2016  * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs
2017  * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics
2018  */
2019 struct cfg80211_tid_stats {
2020 	u32 filled;
2021 	u64 rx_msdu;
2022 	u64 tx_msdu;
2023 	u64 tx_msdu_retries;
2024 	u64 tx_msdu_failed;
2025 	struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats;
2026 };
2027 
2028 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS	4
2029 
2030 /**
2031  * struct station_info - station information
2032  *
2033  * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station.
2034  *
2035  * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to
2036  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
2037  * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected
2038  * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds
2039  * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association
2040  * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station
2041  * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station
2042  * @llid: mesh local link id
2043  * @plid: mesh peer link id
2044  * @plink_state: mesh peer link state
2045  * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
2046  *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
2047  * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
2048  *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
2049  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg
2050  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm
2051  * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm
2052  * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station
2053  * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station
2054  * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station
2055  * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station
2056  * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs)
2057  * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK)
2058  * @rx_dropped_misc:  Dropped for un-specified reason.
2059  * @bss_param: current BSS parameters
2060  * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
2061  *	This number should increase every time the list of stations
2062  *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
2063  *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
2064  * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request.
2065  *	This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use
2066  *	user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for
2067  *	the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs.
2068  * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets.
2069  * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values
2070  * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered.
2071  * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host.
2072  * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode
2073  * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode
2074  * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode
2075  * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers)
2076  *	towards this station.
2077  * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer
2078  * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received
2079  *	from this peer
2080  * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate
2081  * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer
2082  * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer
2083  * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight
2084  * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last
2085  *	(IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs.
2086  *	Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL.
2087  * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame.
2088  * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has
2089  *	been sent.
2090  * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station
2091  * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with
2092  *	an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the
2093  *	received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address.
2094  * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric.
2095  * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server
2096  * @mlo_params_valid: Indicates @assoc_link_id and @mld_addr fields are filled
2097  *	by driver. Drivers use this only in cfg80211_new_sta() calls when AP
2098  *	MLD's MLME/SME is offload to driver. Drivers won't fill this
2099  *	information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and
2100  *	dump_station() callbacks.
2101  * @assoc_link_id: Indicates MLO link ID of the AP, with which the station
2102  *	completed (re)association. This information filled for both MLO
2103  *	and non-MLO STA connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD.
2104  * @mld_addr: For MLO STA connection, filled with MLD address of the station.
2105  *	For non-MLO STA connection, filled with all zeros.
2106  * @assoc_resp_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Response.
2107  *	This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use user
2108  *	space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided only for the
2109  *	cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. Drivers won't
2110  *	fill this information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and
2111  *	dump_station() callbacks. User space needs this information to determine
2112  *	the accepted and rejected affiliated links of the connected station.
2113  * @assoc_resp_ies_len: Length of @assoc_resp_ies buffer in octets.
2114  */
2115 struct station_info {
2116 	u64 filled;
2117 	u32 connected_time;
2118 	u32 inactive_time;
2119 	u64 assoc_at;
2120 	u64 rx_bytes;
2121 	u64 tx_bytes;
2122 	u16 llid;
2123 	u16 plid;
2124 	u8 plink_state;
2125 	s8 signal;
2126 	s8 signal_avg;
2127 
2128 	u8 chains;
2129 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2130 	s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2131 
2132 	struct rate_info txrate;
2133 	struct rate_info rxrate;
2134 	u32 rx_packets;
2135 	u32 tx_packets;
2136 	u32 tx_retries;
2137 	u32 tx_failed;
2138 	u32 rx_dropped_misc;
2139 	struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param;
2140 	struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags;
2141 
2142 	int generation;
2143 
2144 	const u8 *assoc_req_ies;
2145 	size_t assoc_req_ies_len;
2146 
2147 	u32 beacon_loss_count;
2148 	s64 t_offset;
2149 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
2150 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm;
2151 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm;
2152 
2153 	u32 expected_throughput;
2154 
2155 	u64 tx_duration;
2156 	u64 rx_duration;
2157 	u64 rx_beacon;
2158 	u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg;
2159 	u8 connected_to_gate;
2160 
2161 	struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid;
2162 	s8 ack_signal;
2163 	s8 avg_ack_signal;
2164 
2165 	u16 airtime_weight;
2166 
2167 	u32 rx_mpdu_count;
2168 	u32 fcs_err_count;
2169 
2170 	u32 airtime_link_metric;
2171 
2172 	u8 connected_to_as;
2173 
2174 	bool mlo_params_valid;
2175 	u8 assoc_link_id;
2176 	u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2177 	const u8 *assoc_resp_ies;
2178 	size_t assoc_resp_ies_len;
2179 };
2180 
2181 /**
2182  * struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs - sub specs limit
2183  * @power: power limitation in 0.25dbm
2184  * @freq_range_index: index the power limitation applies to
2185  */
2186 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs {
2187 	s32 power;
2188 	u32 freq_range_index;
2189 };
2190 
2191 /**
2192  * struct cfg80211_sar_specs - sar limit specs
2193  * @type: it's set with power in 0.25dbm or other types
2194  * @num_sub_specs: number of sar sub specs
2195  * @sub_specs: memory to hold the sar sub specs
2196  */
2197 struct cfg80211_sar_specs {
2198 	enum nl80211_sar_type type;
2199 	u32 num_sub_specs;
2200 	struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs sub_specs[];
2201 };
2202 
2203 
2204 /**
2205  * struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges - sar frequency ranges
2206  * @start_freq:  start range edge frequency
2207  * @end_freq:    end range edge frequency
2208  */
2209 struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges {
2210 	u32 start_freq;
2211 	u32 end_freq;
2212 };
2213 
2214 /**
2215  * struct cfg80211_sar_capa - sar limit capability
2216  * @type: it's set via power in 0.25dbm or other types
2217  * @num_freq_ranges: number of frequency ranges
2218  * @freq_ranges: memory to hold the freq ranges.
2219  *
2220  * Note: WLAN driver may append new ranges or split an existing
2221  * range to small ones and then append them.
2222  */
2223 struct cfg80211_sar_capa {
2224 	enum nl80211_sar_type type;
2225 	u32 num_freq_ranges;
2226 	const struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges *freq_ranges;
2227 };
2228 
2229 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
2230 /**
2231  * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station
2232  * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to
2233  * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest
2234  * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information
2235  *
2236  * Return: 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information
2237  * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be
2238  * considered undefined.
2239  */
2240 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
2241 			 struct station_info *sinfo);
2242 #else
2243 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev,
2244 				       const u8 *mac_addr,
2245 				       struct station_info *sinfo)
2246 {
2247 	return -ENOENT;
2248 }
2249 #endif
2250 
2251 /**
2252  * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags
2253  *
2254  * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits
2255  * according to the nl80211 flags.
2256  *
2257  * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed
2258  * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
2259  * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
2260  * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
2261  * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
2262  * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing
2263  * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address
2264  */
2265 enum monitor_flags {
2266 	MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED		= 1<<__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
2267 	MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
2268 	MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
2269 	MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
2270 	MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
2271 	MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES	= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
2272 	MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
2273 };
2274 
2275 /**
2276  * enum mpath_info_flags -  mesh path information flags
2277  *
2278  * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled
2279  * in during get_station() or dump_station().
2280  *
2281  * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled
2282  * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled
2283  * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled
2284  * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled
2285  * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled
2286  * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled
2287  * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled
2288  * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled
2289  * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled
2290  */
2291 enum mpath_info_flags {
2292 	MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN		= BIT(0),
2293 	MPATH_INFO_SN			= BIT(1),
2294 	MPATH_INFO_METRIC		= BIT(2),
2295 	MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME		= BIT(3),
2296 	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT	= BIT(4),
2297 	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES	= BIT(5),
2298 	MPATH_INFO_FLAGS		= BIT(6),
2299 	MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT		= BIT(7),
2300 	MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE		= BIT(8),
2301 };
2302 
2303 /**
2304  * struct mpath_info - mesh path information
2305  *
2306  * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath().
2307  *
2308  * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags
2309  * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination
2310  * @sn: target sequence number
2311  * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path
2312  * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs
2313  * @flags: mesh path flags from &enum mesh_path_flags
2314  * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs
2315  * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries
2316  * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
2317  *	This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths
2318  *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
2319  *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
2320  * @hop_count: hops to destination
2321  * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination
2322  */
2323 struct mpath_info {
2324 	u32 filled;
2325 	u32 frame_qlen;
2326 	u32 sn;
2327 	u32 metric;
2328 	u32 exptime;
2329 	u32 discovery_timeout;
2330 	u8 discovery_retries;
2331 	u8 flags;
2332 	u8 hop_count;
2333 	u32 path_change_count;
2334 
2335 	int generation;
2336 };
2337 
2338 /**
2339  * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters
2340  *
2341  * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode).
2342  *
2343  * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD
2344  * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection
2345  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2346  * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed
2347  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2348  * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed
2349  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2350  * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format
2351  *	(or NULL for no change)
2352  * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates
2353  * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations
2354  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2355  * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode
2356  *	(u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change)
2357  * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change)
2358  * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change)
2359  */
2360 struct bss_parameters {
2361 	int link_id;
2362 	int use_cts_prot;
2363 	int use_short_preamble;
2364 	int use_short_slot_time;
2365 	const u8 *basic_rates;
2366 	u8 basic_rates_len;
2367 	int ap_isolate;
2368 	int ht_opmode;
2369 	s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps;
2370 };
2371 
2372 /**
2373  * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration
2374  *
2375  * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active.
2376  *
2377  * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used
2378  *	by the Mesh Peering Open message
2379  * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units
2380  *	used by the Mesh Peering Open message
2381  * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by
2382  *	the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering
2383  * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this
2384  *	mesh interface
2385  * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can
2386  *	be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh
2387  * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA
2388  * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection
2389  *	elements
2390  * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we
2391  *	detect compatible mesh peers
2392  * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to
2393  *	synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
2394  * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ
2395  *	that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target
2396  * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds
2397  * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on
2398  *	a path discovery in milliseconds
2399  * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2400  *	receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the
2401  *	root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
2402  * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
2403  *	which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
2404  *	element
2405  * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
2406  *	which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR
2407  *	element
2408  * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that
2409  *	it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh
2410  * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA
2411  * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root
2412  *	announcements are transmitted
2413  * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh
2414  *	station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is
2415  *	missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true
2416  *	only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but
2417  *	not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the
2418  *	same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec)
2419  * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding
2420  *	entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
2421  * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate
2422  *	station to establish a peer link
2423  * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode
2424  *
2425  * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2426  *	receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to
2427  *	the root mesh STA to be valid.
2428  *
2429  * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive
2430  *	PREQs are transmitted.
2431  * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs)
2432  *	during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing
2433  *	a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
2434  * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial
2435  *	setting for new peer links.
2436  * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake
2437  *	after transmitting its beacon.
2438  * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established
2439  *	peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it
2440  *	from the STA's list of peers.  Default is 30 minutes.
2441  * @dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer: if set to true then this mesh STA
2442  *	will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server
2443  *	in the mesh formation field.
2444  * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is
2445  *      connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info.  If false, the
2446  *      value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths
2447  *      in the mesh path table
2448  * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP
2449  *      for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might
2450  *      not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So
2451  *      if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
2452  *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
2453  */
2454 struct mesh_config {
2455 	u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout;
2456 	u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout;
2457 	u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout;
2458 	u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks;
2459 	u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries;
2460 	u8 dot11MeshTTL;
2461 	u8 element_ttl;
2462 	bool auto_open_plinks;
2463 	u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor;
2464 	u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries;
2465 	u32 path_refresh_time;
2466 	u16 min_discovery_timeout;
2467 	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout;
2468 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval;
2469 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval;
2470 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime;
2471 	u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode;
2472 	bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate;
2473 	bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer;
2474 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval;
2475 	bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol;
2476 	bool dot11MeshForwarding;
2477 	s32 rssi_threshold;
2478 	u16 ht_opmode;
2479 	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout;
2480 	u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval;
2481 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval;
2482 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode;
2483 	u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration;
2484 	u32 plink_timeout;
2485 	bool dot11MeshNolearn;
2486 };
2487 
2488 /**
2489  * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration
2490  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2491  * @mesh_id: the mesh ID
2492  * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes
2493  * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use
2494  * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use
2495  * @path_metric: which metric to use
2496  * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using
2497  * @ie: vendor information elements (optional)
2498  * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements
2499  * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication
2500  * @is_secure: this mesh uses security
2501  * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions
2502  * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use
2503  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
2504  * @mcast_rate: multicast rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a]
2505  * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh
2506  * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
2507  * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
2508  *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
2509  *	to operate on DFS channels.
2510  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
2511  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
2512  *
2513  * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created.
2514  */
2515 struct mesh_setup {
2516 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2517 	const u8 *mesh_id;
2518 	u8 mesh_id_len;
2519 	u8 sync_method;
2520 	u8 path_sel_proto;
2521 	u8 path_metric;
2522 	u8 auth_id;
2523 	const u8 *ie;
2524 	u8 ie_len;
2525 	bool is_authenticated;
2526 	bool is_secure;
2527 	bool user_mpm;
2528 	u8 dtim_period;
2529 	u16 beacon_interval;
2530 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2531 	u32 basic_rates;
2532 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
2533 	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2534 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2535 };
2536 
2537 /**
2538  * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration
2539  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2540  *
2541  * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network
2542  */
2543 struct ocb_setup {
2544 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2545 };
2546 
2547 /**
2548  * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters
2549  * @ac: AC identifier
2550  * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
2551  * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2552  *	1..32767]
2553  * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2554  *	1..32767]
2555  * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
2556  * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD
2557  */
2558 struct ieee80211_txq_params {
2559 	enum nl80211_ac ac;
2560 	u16 txop;
2561 	u16 cwmin;
2562 	u16 cwmax;
2563 	u8 aifs;
2564 	int link_id;
2565 };
2566 
2567 /**
2568  * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling
2569  *
2570  * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite
2571  * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will
2572  * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the
2573  * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the
2574  * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to
2575  * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements
2576  * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be
2577  * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised
2578  * in the wiphy structure.
2579  *
2580  * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because
2581  * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not
2582  * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist.
2583  *
2584  * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of
2585  * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the
2586  * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available
2587  * to userspace.
2588  */
2589 
2590 /**
2591  * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description
2592  * @ssid: the SSID
2593  * @ssid_len: length of the ssid
2594  */
2595 struct cfg80211_ssid {
2596 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
2597 	u8 ssid_len;
2598 };
2599 
2600 /**
2601  * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan
2602  * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the
2603  *	wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this
2604  *	information is not available, this field is left zero.
2605  * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set.
2606  * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason,
2607  *	userspace will be notified of that
2608  */
2609 struct cfg80211_scan_info {
2610 	u64 scan_start_tsf;
2611 	u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2612 	bool aborted;
2613 };
2614 
2615 /**
2616  * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only
2617  *
2618  * @short_ssid: short ssid to scan for
2619  * @bssid: bssid to scan for
2620  * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request
2621  *	 which the above info is relevant to
2622  * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU
2623  * @short_ssid_valid: @short_ssid is valid and can be used
2624  * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait
2625  *       20 TUs before starting to send probe requests.
2626  * @psd_20: The AP's 20 MHz PSD value.
2627  */
2628 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params {
2629 	u32 short_ssid;
2630 	u32 channel_idx;
2631 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2632 	bool unsolicited_probe;
2633 	bool short_ssid_valid;
2634 	bool psc_no_listen;
2635 	s8 psd_20;
2636 };
2637 
2638 /**
2639  * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description
2640  *
2641  * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only)
2642  * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2643  * @channels: channels to scan on.
2644  * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2645  * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2646  * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2647  * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If
2648  *	%duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and
2649  *	the actual dwell time may be shorter.
2650  * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the
2651  *	%duration field.
2652  * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags
2653  * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band
2654  * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2655  * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started
2656  * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for
2657  * @info: (internal) information about completed scan
2658  * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted
2659  * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band
2660  * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2661  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2662  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2663  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2664  * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only,
2665  *	true if this is the second scan request
2666  * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params
2667  * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params
2668  * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID)
2669  * @tsf_report_link_id: for MLO, indicates the link ID of the BSS that should be
2670  *      used for TSF reporting. Can be set to -1 to indicate no preference.
2671  */
2672 struct cfg80211_scan_request {
2673 	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2674 	int n_ssids;
2675 	u32 n_channels;
2676 	const u8 *ie;
2677 	size_t ie_len;
2678 	u16 duration;
2679 	bool duration_mandatory;
2680 	u32 flags;
2681 
2682 	u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2683 
2684 	struct wireless_dev *wdev;
2685 
2686 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2687 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2688 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2689 
2690 	/* internal */
2691 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2692 	unsigned long scan_start;
2693 	struct cfg80211_scan_info info;
2694 	bool notified;
2695 	bool no_cck;
2696 	bool scan_6ghz;
2697 	u32 n_6ghz_params;
2698 	struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params;
2699 	s8 tsf_report_link_id;
2700 
2701 	/* keep last */
2702 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[] __counted_by(n_channels);
2703 };
2704 
2705 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask)
2706 {
2707 	int i;
2708 
2709 	get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN);
2710 	for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) {
2711 		buf[i] &= ~mask[i];
2712 		buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i];
2713 	}
2714 }
2715 
2716 /**
2717  * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match
2718  *
2719  * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match
2720  *	or no match (RSSI only)
2721  * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match
2722  *	or no match (RSSI only)
2723  * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm)
2724  */
2725 struct cfg80211_match_set {
2726 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
2727 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2728 	s32 rssi_thold;
2729 };
2730 
2731 /**
2732  * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan
2733  *
2734  * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds.
2735  * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means
2736  *	infinite loop.
2737  *	The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero,
2738  *	all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations.
2739  */
2740 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan {
2741 	u32 interval;
2742 	u32 iterations;
2743 };
2744 
2745 /**
2746  * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment.
2747  *
2748  * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment.
2749  * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment.
2750  */
2751 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust {
2752 	enum nl80211_band band;
2753 	s8 delta;
2754 };
2755 
2756 /**
2757  * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description
2758  *
2759  * @reqid: identifies this request.
2760  * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans)
2761  * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2762  * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2763  * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2764  * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2765  * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags
2766  * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result
2767  *	entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host
2768  *	(others are filtered out).
2769  *	If omitted, all results are passed.
2770  * @n_match_sets: number of match sets
2771  * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request
2772  * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2773  * @dev: the interface
2774  * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan
2775  * @channels: channels to scan
2776  * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this
2777  *	contains the minimum over all matchsets
2778  * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2779  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2780  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2781  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2782  * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest
2783  *	index must be executed first.
2784  * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1.
2785  * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct
2786  * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request
2787  *	owned by a particular socket)
2788  * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed
2789  * @list: for keeping list of requests.
2790  * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan
2791  *	cycle.  The driver may ignore this parameter and start
2792  *	immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not
2793  *	supported.
2794  * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not.
2795  * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result
2796  *	reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined
2797  *	to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS.
2798  *	The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state.
2799  * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong
2800  *	to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported
2801  *	using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that
2802  *	belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative
2803  *	comparisons.
2804  */
2805 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request {
2806 	u64 reqid;
2807 	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2808 	int n_ssids;
2809 	u32 n_channels;
2810 	const u8 *ie;
2811 	size_t ie_len;
2812 	u32 flags;
2813 	struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets;
2814 	int n_match_sets;
2815 	s32 min_rssi_thold;
2816 	u32 delay;
2817 	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans;
2818 	int n_scan_plans;
2819 
2820 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2821 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2822 
2823 	bool relative_rssi_set;
2824 	s8 relative_rssi;
2825 	struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust;
2826 
2827 	/* internal */
2828 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2829 	struct net_device *dev;
2830 	unsigned long scan_start;
2831 	bool report_results;
2832 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2833 	u32 owner_nlportid;
2834 	bool nl_owner_dead;
2835 	struct list_head list;
2836 
2837 	/* keep last */
2838 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[];
2839 };
2840 
2841 /**
2842  * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type
2843  *
2844  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available
2845  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm)
2846  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100
2847  */
2848 enum cfg80211_signal_type {
2849 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE,
2850 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM,
2851 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC,
2852 };
2853 
2854 /**
2855  * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data
2856  * @chan: channel the frame was received on
2857  * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's
2858  *	signal type
2859  * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was
2860  *	received; should match the time when the frame was actually
2861  *	received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was
2862  *	buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms.
2863  *	If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of
2864  *	ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate.
2865  * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the
2866  *	timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified
2867  *	by %parent_bssid.
2868  * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to
2869  *	the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received.
2870  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2871  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2872  * @restrict_use: restrict usage, if not set, assume @use_for is
2873  *	%NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL.
2874  * @use_for: bitmap of possible usage for this BSS, see
2875  *	&enum nl80211_bss_use_for
2876  * @cannot_use_reasons: the reasons (bitmap) for not being able to connect,
2877  *	if @restrict_use is set and @use_for is zero (empty); may be 0 for
2878  *	unspecified reasons; see &enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons
2879  * @drv_data: Data to be passed through to @inform_bss
2880  */
2881 struct cfg80211_inform_bss {
2882 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
2883 	s32 signal;
2884 	u64 boottime_ns;
2885 	u64 parent_tsf;
2886 	u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2887 	u8 chains;
2888 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2889 
2890 	u8 restrict_use:1, use_for:7;
2891 	u8 cannot_use_reasons;
2892 
2893 	void *drv_data;
2894 };
2895 
2896 /**
2897  * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data
2898  * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs
2899  * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing
2900  * @len: length of the IEs
2901  * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon
2902  * @data: IE data
2903  */
2904 struct cfg80211_bss_ies {
2905 	u64 tsf;
2906 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2907 	int len;
2908 	bool from_beacon;
2909 	u8 data[];
2910 };
2911 
2912 /**
2913  * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description
2914  *
2915  * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network)
2916  * for use in scan results and similar.
2917  *
2918  * @channel: channel this BSS is on
2919  * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS
2920  * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame
2921  * @capability: the capability field in host byte order
2922  * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these
2923  *	are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or
2924  *	proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been
2925  *	received. It is always non-%NULL.
2926  * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame
2927  *	(implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't
2928  *	own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the
2929  *	@hidden_beacon_bss struct)
2930  * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame
2931  * @proberesp_ecsa_stuck: ECSA element is stuck in the Probe Response frame,
2932  *	cannot rely on it having valid data
2933  * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from
2934  *	a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct
2935  *	that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and
2936  *	points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case.
2937  * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a
2938  *	non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support)
2939  * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one
2940  *	(multi-BSSID support)
2941  * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type)
2942  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2943  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2944  * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set
2945  * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set
2946  * @use_for: bitmap of possible usage for this BSS, see
2947  *	&enum nl80211_bss_use_for
2948  * @cannot_use_reasons: the reasons (bitmap) for not being able to connect,
2949  *	if @restrict_use is set and @use_for is zero (empty); may be 0 for
2950  *	unspecified reasons; see &enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons
2951  * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes
2952  */
2953 struct cfg80211_bss {
2954 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2955 
2956 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies;
2957 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies;
2958 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies;
2959 
2960 	struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss;
2961 	struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss;
2962 	struct list_head nontrans_list;
2963 
2964 	s32 signal;
2965 
2966 	u16 beacon_interval;
2967 	u16 capability;
2968 
2969 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2970 	u8 chains;
2971 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2972 
2973 	u8 proberesp_ecsa_stuck:1;
2974 
2975 	u8 bssid_index;
2976 	u8 max_bssid_indicator;
2977 
2978 	u8 use_for;
2979 	u8 cannot_use_reasons;
2980 
2981 	u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2982 };
2983 
2984 /**
2985  * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID
2986  * @bss: the bss to search
2987  * @id: the element ID
2988  *
2989  * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2990  * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2991  * Return: %NULL if not found.
2992  */
2993 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id);
2994 
2995 /**
2996  * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID
2997  * @bss: the bss to search
2998  * @id: the element ID
2999  *
3000  * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
3001  * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
3002  * Return: %NULL if not found.
3003  */
3004 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id)
3005 {
3006 	return (const void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id);
3007 }
3008 
3009 
3010 /**
3011  * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data
3012  *
3013  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3014  * authentication.
3015  *
3016  * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference
3017  *	to it if it needs to keep it.
3018  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
3019  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL
3020  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3021  * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
3022  * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
3023  * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
3024  * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains
3025  *	the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the
3026  *	Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication
3027  *	transaction sequence number field.
3028  * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets
3029  * @link_id: if >= 0, indicates authentication should be done as an MLD,
3030  *	the interface address is included as the MLD address and the
3031  *	necessary link (with the given link_id) will be created (and
3032  *	given an MLD address) by the driver
3033  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of authentication request with
3034  *	an AP MLD, valid iff @link_id >= 0
3035  */
3036 struct cfg80211_auth_request {
3037 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3038 	const u8 *ie;
3039 	size_t ie_len;
3040 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
3041 	const u8 *key;
3042 	u8 key_len;
3043 	s8 key_idx;
3044 	const u8 *auth_data;
3045 	size_t auth_data_len;
3046 	s8 link_id;
3047 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
3048 };
3049 
3050 /**
3051  * struct cfg80211_assoc_link - per-link information for MLO association
3052  * @bss: the BSS pointer, see also &struct cfg80211_assoc_request::bss;
3053  *	if this is %NULL for a link, that link is not requested
3054  * @elems: extra elements for the per-STA profile for this link
3055  * @elems_len: length of the elements
3056  * @disabled: If set this link should be included during association etc. but it
3057  *	should not be used until enabled by the AP MLD.
3058  * @error: per-link error code, must be <= 0. If there is an error, then the
3059  *	operation as a whole must fail.
3060  */
3061 struct cfg80211_assoc_link {
3062 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3063 	const u8 *elems;
3064 	size_t elems_len;
3065 	bool disabled;
3066 	int error;
3067 };
3068 
3069 /**
3070  * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association.
3071  *
3072  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT:  Disable HT (802.11n)
3073  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT:  Disable VHT
3074  * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association
3075  * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external
3076  *	authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to
3077  *	userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect()
3078  *	request (connect callback).
3079  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE:  Disable HE
3080  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT:  Disable EHT
3081  * @CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT: Userspace indicates support for handling MLD links.
3082  *	Drivers shall disable MLO features for the current association if this
3083  *	flag is not set.
3084  * @ASSOC_REQ_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs will be used on this connection (if any)
3085  */
3086 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags {
3087 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT			= BIT(0),
3088 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT			= BIT(1),
3089 	ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM			= BIT(2),
3090 	CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT	= BIT(3),
3091 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE			= BIT(4),
3092 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT			= BIT(5),
3093 	CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT			= BIT(6),
3094 	ASSOC_REQ_SPP_AMSDU			= BIT(7),
3095 };
3096 
3097 /**
3098  * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data
3099  *
3100  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3101  * (re)association.
3102  * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is
3103  *	given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc()
3104  *	or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new
3105  *	association requests while already associating must be rejected.
3106  *	This also applies to the @links.bss parameter, which is used instead
3107  *	of this one (it is %NULL) for MLO associations.
3108  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL
3109  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3110  * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association
3111  * @crypto: crypto settings
3112  * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
3113  *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
3114  *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
3115  *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
3116  *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
3117  *	frame.
3118  * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
3119  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
3120  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
3121  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3122  * @vht_capa: VHT capability override
3123  * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use
3124  * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or
3125  *	%NULL if FILS is not used.
3126  * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets
3127  * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association
3128  *	Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts
3129  *	with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
3130  * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override
3131  * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask
3132  * @links: per-link information for MLO connections
3133  * @link_id: >= 0 for MLO connections, where links are given, and indicates
3134  *	the link on which the association request should be sent
3135  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of MLO association request,
3136  *	valid iff @link_id >= 0
3137  */
3138 struct cfg80211_assoc_request {
3139 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3140 	const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid;
3141 	size_t ie_len;
3142 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
3143 	bool use_mfp;
3144 	u32 flags;
3145 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3146 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3147 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask;
3148 	const u8 *fils_kek;
3149 	size_t fils_kek_len;
3150 	const u8 *fils_nonces;
3151 	struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask;
3152 	struct cfg80211_assoc_link links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
3153 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
3154 	s8 link_id;
3155 };
3156 
3157 /**
3158  * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data
3159  *
3160  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3161  * deauthentication.
3162  *
3163  * @bssid: the BSSID or AP MLD address to deauthenticate from
3164  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL
3165  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3166  * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication
3167  * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and
3168  *	do not set a deauth frame
3169  */
3170 struct cfg80211_deauth_request {
3171 	const u8 *bssid;
3172 	const u8 *ie;
3173 	size_t ie_len;
3174 	u16 reason_code;
3175 	bool local_state_change;
3176 };
3177 
3178 /**
3179  * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data
3180  *
3181  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3182  * disassociation.
3183  *
3184  * @ap_addr: the BSSID or AP MLD address to disassociate from
3185  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL
3186  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3187  * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation
3188  * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no
3189  *	Disassociation frame is to be transmitted.
3190  */
3191 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request {
3192 	const u8 *ap_addr;
3193 	const u8 *ie;
3194 	size_t ie_len;
3195 	u16 reason_code;
3196 	bool local_state_change;
3197 };
3198 
3199 /**
3200  * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters
3201  *
3202  * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss()
3203  * method.
3204  *
3205  * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null.
3206  * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero.
3207  * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not
3208  *	search for IBSSs with a different BSSID.
3209  * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found
3210  * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for
3211  *	IBSSs to join on other channels.
3212  * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon
3213  * @ie_len: length of that
3214  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
3215  * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured
3216  *	after joining
3217  * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
3218  *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
3219  *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
3220  *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
3221  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
3222  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
3223  * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
3224  *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
3225  *	to operate on DFS channels.
3226  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS
3227  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
3228  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
3229  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
3230  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3231  * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
3232  *	CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
3233  * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
3234  */
3235 struct cfg80211_ibss_params {
3236 	const u8 *ssid;
3237 	const u8 *bssid;
3238 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
3239 	const u8 *ie;
3240 	u8 ssid_len, ie_len;
3241 	u16 beacon_interval;
3242 	u32 basic_rates;
3243 	bool channel_fixed;
3244 	bool privacy;
3245 	bool control_port;
3246 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
3247 	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
3248 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
3249 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3250 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3251 	struct key_params *wep_keys;
3252 	int wep_tx_key;
3253 };
3254 
3255 /**
3256  * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection.
3257  *
3258  * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour.
3259  * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour.
3260  * @param.band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF.
3261  * @param.adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST.
3262  */
3263 struct cfg80211_bss_selection {
3264 	enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour;
3265 	union {
3266 		enum nl80211_band band_pref;
3267 		struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust;
3268 	} param;
3269 };
3270 
3271 /**
3272  * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters
3273  *
3274  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3275  * authentication and association.
3276  *
3277  * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based
3278  *	on scan results)
3279  * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or
3280  *	%NULL if not specified
3281  * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan
3282  *	results)
3283  * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or
3284  *	%NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is
3285  *	allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS
3286  *	to use.
3287  * @ssid: SSID
3288  * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets
3289  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
3290  * @ie: IEs for association request
3291  * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets
3292  * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used
3293  * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used
3294  * @crypto: crypto settings
3295  * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
3296  * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
3297  * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
3298  * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
3299  * @bg_scan_period:  Background scan period in seconds
3300  *	or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used.
3301  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
3302  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
3303  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3304  * @vht_capa:  VHT Capability overrides
3305  * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used.
3306  * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG
3307  *	networks.
3308  * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection.
3309  * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
3310  *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
3311  *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
3312  *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
3313  *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
3314  *	frame.
3315  * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the
3316  *	NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped
3317  *	data IE.
3318  * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets.
3319  * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or
3320  *	%NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and
3321  *	is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
3322  * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets.
3323  * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP
3324  *	messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
3325  * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional
3326  *	keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified.
3327  * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets.
3328  * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver
3329  *	offload of 4-way handshake.
3330  * @edmg: define the EDMG channels.
3331  *	This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver
3332  *	to choose from, based on BSS configuration.
3333  */
3334 struct cfg80211_connect_params {
3335 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
3336 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint;
3337 	const u8 *bssid;
3338 	const u8 *bssid_hint;
3339 	const u8 *ssid;
3340 	size_t ssid_len;
3341 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
3342 	const u8 *ie;
3343 	size_t ie_len;
3344 	bool privacy;
3345 	enum nl80211_mfp mfp;
3346 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
3347 	const u8 *key;
3348 	u8 key_len, key_idx;
3349 	u32 flags;
3350 	int bg_scan_period;
3351 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3352 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3353 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa;
3354 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask;
3355 	bool pbss;
3356 	struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select;
3357 	const u8 *prev_bssid;
3358 	const u8 *fils_erp_username;
3359 	size_t fils_erp_username_len;
3360 	const u8 *fils_erp_realm;
3361 	size_t fils_erp_realm_len;
3362 	u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num;
3363 	const u8 *fils_erp_rrk;
3364 	size_t fils_erp_rrk_len;
3365 	bool want_1x;
3366 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
3367 };
3368 
3369 /**
3370  * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated
3371  *
3372  * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that
3373  * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call.
3374  *
3375  * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated
3376  * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm,
3377  *	username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated
3378  * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated
3379  */
3380 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed {
3381 	UPDATE_ASSOC_IES		= BIT(0),
3382 	UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO		= BIT(1),
3383 	UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE		= BIT(2),
3384 };
3385 
3386 /**
3387  * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values
3388  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed
3389  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed
3390  * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed
3391  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed
3392  * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed
3393  * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled
3394  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed
3395  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed
3396  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum
3397  */
3398 enum wiphy_params_flags {
3399 	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT		= 1 << 0,
3400 	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG		= 1 << 1,
3401 	WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 2,
3402 	WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 3,
3403 	WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS	= 1 << 4,
3404 	WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK		= 1 << 5,
3405 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT		= 1 << 6,
3406 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT	= 1 << 7,
3407 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM		= 1 << 8,
3408 };
3409 
3410 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT	256
3411 
3412 /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */
3413 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L	5000
3414 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H	12000
3415 
3416 /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */
3417 #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD			24000
3418 
3419 /**
3420  * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association
3421  *
3422  * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA
3423  * caching.
3424  *
3425  * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL).
3426  * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3427  * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key
3428  *	derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL.
3429  * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on
3430  *	the hash algorithm used to generate this.
3431  * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS
3432  *	cache identifier (may be %NULL).
3433  * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets.
3434  * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the
3435  *	scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be
3436  *	%NULL).
3437  * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds
3438  *	(dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified.
3439  *	The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after
3440  *	expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on
3441  *	expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK
3442  *	used for it expires.
3443  * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of
3444  *	PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified.
3445  *	Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using
3446  *	this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this
3447  *	threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires.
3448  */
3449 struct cfg80211_pmksa {
3450 	const u8 *bssid;
3451 	const u8 *pmkid;
3452 	const u8 *pmk;
3453 	size_t pmk_len;
3454 	const u8 *ssid;
3455 	size_t ssid_len;
3456 	const u8 *cache_id;
3457 	u32 pmk_lifetime;
3458 	u8 pmk_reauth_threshold;
3459 };
3460 
3461 /**
3462  * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern
3463  * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes,
3464  *	one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211
3465  * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1
3466  * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes)
3467  * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes)
3468  *
3469  * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of
3470  * memory, free @mask only!
3471  */
3472 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern {
3473 	const u8 *mask, *pattern;
3474 	int pattern_len;
3475 	int pkt_offset;
3476 };
3477 
3478 /**
3479  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters
3480  *
3481  * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation
3482  * @src: source IP address
3483  * @dst: destination IP address
3484  * @dst_mac: destination MAC address
3485  * @src_port: source port
3486  * @dst_port: destination port
3487  * @payload_len: data payload length
3488  * @payload: data payload buffer
3489  * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration
3490  * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets
3491  * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length
3492  * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data
3493  * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask
3494  * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer
3495  * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration
3496  */
3497 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp {
3498 	struct socket *sock;
3499 	__be32 src, dst;
3500 	u16 src_port, dst_port;
3501 	u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN];
3502 	int payload_len;
3503 	const u8 *payload;
3504 	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq;
3505 	u32 data_interval;
3506 	u32 wake_len;
3507 	const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask;
3508 	u32 tokens_size;
3509 	/* must be last, variable member */
3510 	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok;
3511 };
3512 
3513 /**
3514  * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info
3515  *
3516  * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device.
3517  * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues
3518  *	operating as normal during suspend
3519  * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected
3520  * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet
3521  * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern
3522  * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3523  * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure
3524  * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet
3525  * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake
3526  * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released
3527  * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h.
3528  *	NULL if not configured.
3529  * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake.
3530  */
3531 struct cfg80211_wowlan {
3532 	bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3533 	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3534 	     rfkill_release;
3535 	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3536 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp;
3537 	int n_patterns;
3538 	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config;
3539 };
3540 
3541 /**
3542  * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters
3543  *
3544  * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device.
3545  * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs.
3546  * @condition: condition for packet coalescence.
3547  *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
3548  * @patterns: array of packet patterns
3549  * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3550  */
3551 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules {
3552 	int delay;
3553 	enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition;
3554 	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3555 	int n_patterns;
3556 };
3557 
3558 /**
3559  * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings
3560  *
3561  * This structure defines coalescing settings.
3562  * @rules: array of coalesce rules
3563  * @n_rules: number of rules
3564  */
3565 struct cfg80211_coalesce {
3566 	struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules *rules;
3567 	int n_rules;
3568 };
3569 
3570 /**
3571  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match
3572  *
3573  * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up
3574  * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred.  This
3575  *	value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels.
3576  * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match
3577  *	occurred (in MHz)
3578  */
3579 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match {
3580 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3581 	int n_channels;
3582 	u32 channels[];
3583 };
3584 
3585 /**
3586  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information
3587  *
3588  * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in
3589  *	@matches.  This value may be zero if the driver can't provide
3590  *	match information.
3591  * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about
3592  *	the matches that triggered the wake up.
3593  */
3594 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info {
3595 	int n_matches;
3596 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[];
3597 };
3598 
3599 /**
3600  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report
3601  * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected
3602  * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet
3603  * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure
3604  * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet
3605  * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake
3606  * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released
3607  * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern
3608  * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data
3609  * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length
3610  * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any.
3611  * @packet_80211:  For pattern match, magic packet and other data
3612  *	frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for
3613  *	disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which
3614  *	it is.
3615  * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received
3616  * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish
3617  * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens
3618  * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect
3619  * @unprot_deauth_disassoc: woke up due to unprotected deauth or
3620  *	disassoc frame (in MFP).
3621  */
3622 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup {
3623 	bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3624 	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3625 	     rfkill_release, packet_80211,
3626 	     tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens,
3627 	     unprot_deauth_disassoc;
3628 	s32 pattern_idx;
3629 	u32 packet_present_len, packet_len;
3630 	const void *packet;
3631 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect;
3632 };
3633 
3634 /**
3635  * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data
3636  * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes)
3637  * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes)
3638  * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes)
3639  * @kek_len: length of kek
3640  * @kck_len: length of kck
3641  * @akm: akm (oui, id)
3642  */
3643 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data {
3644 	const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr;
3645 	u32 akm;
3646 	u8 kek_len, kck_len;
3647 };
3648 
3649 /**
3650  * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information
3651  *
3652  * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE
3653  *
3654  * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value
3655  * @ie: Fast Transition IEs
3656  * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets
3657  */
3658 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params {
3659 	u16 md;
3660 	const u8 *ie;
3661 	size_t ie_len;
3662 };
3663 
3664 /**
3665  * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters
3666  *
3667  * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame
3668  *
3669  * @chan: channel to use
3670  * @offchan: indicates whether off channel operation is required
3671  * @wait: duration for ROC
3672  * @buf: buffer to transmit
3673  * @len: buffer length
3674  * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame
3675  * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack
3676  * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array
3677  * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame
3678  * @link_id: for MLO, the link ID to transmit on, -1 if not given; note
3679  *	that the link ID isn't validated (much), it's in range but the
3680  *	link might not exist (or be used by the receiver STA)
3681  */
3682 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params {
3683 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
3684 	bool offchan;
3685 	unsigned int wait;
3686 	const u8 *buf;
3687 	size_t len;
3688 	bool no_cck;
3689 	bool dont_wait_for_ack;
3690 	int n_csa_offsets;
3691 	const u16 *csa_offsets;
3692 	int link_id;
3693 };
3694 
3695 /**
3696  * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception
3697  *
3698  * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition
3699  * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs
3700  */
3701 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception {
3702 	u8 dscp;
3703 	u8 up;
3704 };
3705 
3706 /**
3707  * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority
3708  *
3709  * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3710  * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3711  */
3712 struct cfg80211_dscp_range {
3713 	u8 low;
3714 	u8 high;
3715 };
3716 
3717 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */
3718 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX	21
3719 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN	16
3720 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \
3721 	(IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX)
3722 
3723 /**
3724  * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information
3725  *
3726  * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values
3727  *
3728  * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21)
3729  * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from
3730  *	the user priority DSCP range definition
3731  * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority
3732  */
3733 struct cfg80211_qos_map {
3734 	u8 num_des;
3735 	struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX];
3736 	struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8];
3737 };
3738 
3739 /**
3740  * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration
3741  *
3742  * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters
3743  *
3744  * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255)
3745  * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.
3746  *	For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
3747  *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
3748  */
3749 struct cfg80211_nan_conf {
3750 	u8 master_pref;
3751 	u8 bands;
3752 };
3753 
3754 /**
3755  * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN
3756  * configuration
3757  *
3758  * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference
3759  * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands
3760  */
3761 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes {
3762 	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0),
3763 	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1),
3764 };
3765 
3766 /**
3767  * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter
3768  *
3769  * @filter: the content of the filter
3770  * @len: the length of the filter
3771  */
3772 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter {
3773 	const u8 *filter;
3774 	u8 len;
3775 };
3776 
3777 /**
3778  * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function
3779  *
3780  * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type
3781  * @service_id: the service ID of the function
3782  * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type
3783  * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is
3784  *	implementation specific.
3785  * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted
3786  * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active
3787  * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up
3788  * @followup_reqid: the requester instance ID for follow up
3789  * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up
3790  * @ttl: time to live counter in DW.
3791  * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info
3792  * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length
3793  * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive
3794  * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter
3795  * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length
3796  * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index
3797  * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses
3798  * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF
3799  * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter
3800  * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF.
3801  * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters.
3802  * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters.
3803  * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function.
3804  * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier.
3805  */
3806 struct cfg80211_nan_func {
3807 	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
3808 	u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN];
3809 	u8 publish_type;
3810 	bool close_range;
3811 	bool publish_bcast;
3812 	bool subscribe_active;
3813 	u8 followup_id;
3814 	u8 followup_reqid;
3815 	struct mac_address followup_dest;
3816 	u32 ttl;
3817 	const u8 *serv_spec_info;
3818 	u8 serv_spec_info_len;
3819 	bool srf_include;
3820 	const u8 *srf_bf;
3821 	u8 srf_bf_len;
3822 	u8 srf_bf_idx;
3823 	struct mac_address *srf_macs;
3824 	int srf_num_macs;
3825 	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters;
3826 	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters;
3827 	u8 num_tx_filters;
3828 	u8 num_rx_filters;
3829 	u8 instance_id;
3830 	u64 cookie;
3831 };
3832 
3833 /**
3834  * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration
3835  *
3836  * @aa: authenticator address
3837  * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes.
3838  * @pmk: the PMK material
3839  * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK
3840  *	is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field
3841  *	holds PMK-R0.
3842  */
3843 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf {
3844 	const u8 *aa;
3845 	u8 pmk_len;
3846 	const u8 *pmk;
3847 	const u8 *pmk_r0_name;
3848 };
3849 
3850 /**
3851  * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication.
3852  *
3853  * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces.
3854  *
3855  * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant
3856  *	for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space).
3857  * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has
3858  *	to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and
3859  *	authentication response command interface.
3860  * @ssid: SSID of the AP.  Used by both the authentication request event and
3861  *	authentication response command interface.
3862  * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the
3863  *	authentication request event interface.
3864  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication,
3865  *	use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you
3866  *	the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication
3867  *	response command interface (user space to driver).
3868  * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3869  * @mld_addr: MLD address of the peer. Used by the authentication request event
3870  *	interface. Driver indicates this to enable MLO during the authentication
3871  *	offload to user space. Driver shall look at %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT
3872  *	flag capability in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space
3873  *	supports enabling MLO during the authentication offload.
3874  *	User space should use the address of the interface (on which the
3875  *	authentication request event reported) as self MLD address. User space
3876  *	and driver should use MLD addresses in RA, TA and BSSID fields of
3877  *	authentication frames sent or received via cfg80211. The driver
3878  *	translates the MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link
3879  *	chosen for the authentication.
3880  */
3881 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params {
3882 	enum nl80211_external_auth_action action;
3883 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3884 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3885 	unsigned int key_mgmt_suite;
3886 	u16 status;
3887 	const u8 *pmkid;
3888 	u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3889 };
3890 
3891 /**
3892  * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
3893  *
3894  * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to
3895  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
3896  * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully
3897  *	answered
3898  * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were
3899  *	successfully answered
3900  * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions
3901  * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions
3902  * @non_asap_num: number of  non-ASAP FTM sessions
3903  * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication
3904  *	of how much time the responder was busy
3905  * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from
3906  *	initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with
3907  *	the responder
3908  * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks
3909  *	for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot
3910  * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window
3911  */
3912 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats {
3913 	u32 filled;
3914 	u32 success_num;
3915 	u32 partial_num;
3916 	u32 failed_num;
3917 	u32 asap_num;
3918 	u32 non_asap_num;
3919 	u64 total_duration_ms;
3920 	u32 unknown_triggers_num;
3921 	u32 reschedule_requests_num;
3922 	u32 out_of_window_triggers_num;
3923 };
3924 
3925 /**
3926  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result
3927  * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is
3928  *	%NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise
3929  *	reason than just "failure"
3930  * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index
3931  *	in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported
3932  * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted
3933  * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked
3934  * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
3935  *	fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible
3936  *	by the responder
3937  * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated
3938  * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated
3939  * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated
3940  * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present)
3941  * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present)
3942  * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL)
3943  * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL)
3944  * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3945  * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3946  * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response
3947  * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame
3948  * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg)
3949  * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is
3950  *	the square root of the variance)
3951  * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured
3952  * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured
3953  *	(must have either this or @rtt_avg)
3954  * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance)
3955  * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread)
3956  * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid
3957  * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid
3958  * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid
3959  * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid
3960  * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid
3961  * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid
3962  * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid
3963  * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid
3964  * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid
3965  * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid
3966  * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid
3967  * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid
3968  */
3969 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result {
3970 	const u8 *lci;
3971 	const u8 *civicloc;
3972 	unsigned int lci_len;
3973 	unsigned int civicloc_len;
3974 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason;
3975 	u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes;
3976 	s16 burst_index;
3977 	u8 busy_retry_time;
3978 	u8 num_bursts_exp;
3979 	u8 burst_duration;
3980 	u8 ftms_per_burst;
3981 	s32 rssi_avg;
3982 	s32 rssi_spread;
3983 	struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate;
3984 	s64 rtt_avg;
3985 	s64 rtt_variance;
3986 	s64 rtt_spread;
3987 	s64 dist_avg;
3988 	s64 dist_variance;
3989 	s64 dist_spread;
3990 
3991 	u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1,
3992 	    num_ftmr_successes_valid:1,
3993 	    rssi_avg_valid:1,
3994 	    rssi_spread_valid:1,
3995 	    tx_rate_valid:1,
3996 	    rx_rate_valid:1,
3997 	    rtt_avg_valid:1,
3998 	    rtt_variance_valid:1,
3999 	    rtt_spread_valid:1,
4000 	    dist_avg_valid:1,
4001 	    dist_variance_valid:1,
4002 	    dist_spread_valid:1;
4003 };
4004 
4005 /**
4006  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result
4007  * @addr: address of the peer
4008  * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the
4009  *	measurement was made)
4010  * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time
4011  * @status: status of the measurement
4012  * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not
4013  *	reporting partial results always set this flag
4014  * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid
4015  * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting
4016  *	one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and
4017  *	they're all aggregated for userspace.
4018  * @ftm: FTM result
4019  */
4020 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result {
4021 	u64 host_time, ap_tsf;
4022 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status;
4023 
4024 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
4025 
4026 	u8 final:1,
4027 	   ap_tsf_valid:1;
4028 
4029 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type;
4030 
4031 	union {
4032 		struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm;
4033 	};
4034 };
4035 
4036 /**
4037  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data
4038  * @requested: indicates FTM is requested
4039  * @preamble: frame preamble to use
4040  * @burst_period: burst period to use
4041  * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode
4042  * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent
4043  * @burst_duration: burst duration
4044  * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst
4045  * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request
4046  * @request_lci: request LCI information
4047  * @request_civicloc: request civic location information
4048  * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement
4049  *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
4050  *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
4051  * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement
4052  *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
4053  *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
4054  * @lmr_feedback: negotiate for I2R LMR feedback. Only valid if either
4055  *		 @trigger_based or @non_trigger_based is set.
4056  * @bss_color: the bss color of the responder. Optional. Set to zero to
4057  *	indicate the driver should set the BSS color. Only valid if
4058  *	@non_trigger_based or @trigger_based is set.
4059  *
4060  * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation.
4061  */
4062 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer {
4063 	enum nl80211_preamble preamble;
4064 	u16 burst_period;
4065 	u8 requested:1,
4066 	   asap:1,
4067 	   request_lci:1,
4068 	   request_civicloc:1,
4069 	   trigger_based:1,
4070 	   non_trigger_based:1,
4071 	   lmr_feedback:1;
4072 	u8 num_bursts_exp;
4073 	u8 burst_duration;
4074 	u8 ftms_per_burst;
4075 	u8 ftmr_retries;
4076 	u8 bss_color;
4077 };
4078 
4079 /**
4080  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request
4081  * @addr: MAC address
4082  * @chandef: channel to use
4083  * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF
4084  * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer
4085  */
4086 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer {
4087 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
4088 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
4089 	u8 report_ap_tsf:1;
4090 	struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm;
4091 };
4092 
4093 /**
4094  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request
4095  * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211
4096  * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211
4097  * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting,
4098  *	not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211
4099  * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request
4100  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that
4101  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
4102  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
4103  * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request
4104  * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if
4105  *	zero it means there's no timeout
4106  * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with
4107  * @peers: per-peer measurement request data
4108  */
4109 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request {
4110 	u64 cookie;
4111 	void *drv_data;
4112 	u32 n_peers;
4113 	u32 nl_portid;
4114 
4115 	u32 timeout;
4116 
4117 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4118 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4119 
4120 	struct list_head list;
4121 
4122 	struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[] __counted_by(n_peers);
4123 };
4124 
4125 /**
4126  * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information
4127  *
4128  * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE
4129  * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space.
4130  *
4131  * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces.
4132  *
4133  * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing
4134  *	has to be done.
4135  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info
4136  *	processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space
4137  *	cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for
4138  *	OWE update request command interface (user space to driver).
4139  * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are
4140  *	the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and
4141  *	the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface.
4142  * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets.
4143  * @assoc_link_id: MLO link ID of the AP, with which (re)association requested
4144  *	by peer. This will be filled by driver for both MLO and non-MLO station
4145  *	connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD. For non-MLD AP mode, it
4146  *	will be -1. Used only with OWE update event (driver to user space).
4147  * @peer_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the peer. For non-MLO
4148  *	connection, it will be all zeros. This is applicable only when
4149  *	@assoc_link_id is not -1, i.e., the AP affiliated with an MLD. Used only
4150  *	with OWE update event (driver to user space).
4151  */
4152 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info {
4153 	u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4154 	u16 status;
4155 	const u8 *ie;
4156 	size_t ie_len;
4157 	int assoc_link_id;
4158 	u8 peer_mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4159 };
4160 
4161 /**
4162  * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data
4163  * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
4164  *	for the entire device
4165  * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
4166  *	for the given interface
4167  * @global_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes
4168  * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface
4169  *	for these subtypes
4170  */
4171 struct mgmt_frame_regs {
4172 	u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes;
4173 	u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes;
4174 };
4175 
4176 /**
4177  * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration
4178  *
4179  * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks
4180  * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces.
4181  *
4182  * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0
4183  * on success or a negative error code.
4184  *
4185  * All operations are invoked with the wiphy mutex held. The RTNL may be
4186  * held in addition (due to wireless extensions) but this cannot be relied
4187  * upon except in cases where documented below. Note that due to ordering,
4188  * the RTNL also cannot be acquired in any handlers.
4189  *
4190  * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will
4191  *	be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are
4192  *	configured for the device.
4193  * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed
4194  * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback
4195  *	to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from
4196  *	the device.
4197  *
4198  * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name,
4199  *	must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create
4200  *	the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct
4201  *	wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must
4202  *	also set the address member in the wdev.
4203  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4204  *
4205  * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface
4206  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4207  *
4208  * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface,
4209  *	keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated.
4210  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4211  *
4212  * @add_intf_link: Add a new MLO link to the given interface. Note that
4213  *	the wdev->link[] data structure has been updated, so the new link
4214  *	address is available.
4215  * @del_intf_link: Remove an MLO link from the given interface.
4216  *
4217  * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL
4218  *	when adding a group key. @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection.
4219  *	For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for
4220  *	pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key.
4221  *
4222  * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters.
4223  *	@mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group
4224  *	key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid
4225  *	after it returns. This function should return an error if it is
4226  *	not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist.
4227  *	@link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection,
4228  *	@link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr
4229  *	will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key.
4230  *
4231  * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key)
4232  *	and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist. @link_id will
4233  *	be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0
4234  *	for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD
4235  *	address for MLO pairwise key.
4236  *
4237  * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface. @link_id will be >= 0
4238  *	for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4239  *
4240  * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface.
4241  *	@link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4242  *
4243  * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface.
4244  *	@link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4245  *
4246  * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver
4247  *
4248  * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters.
4249  * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode
4250  *	interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started.
4251  * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing.
4252  *
4253  * @add_station: Add a new station.
4254  * @del_station: Remove a station
4255  * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much
4256  *	validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags
4257  *	might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check
4258  *	them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call
4259  *	cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information.
4260  * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac
4261  * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4262  *
4263  * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path
4264  * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path
4265  * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path
4266  * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters
4267  * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4268  * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters
4269  * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4270  * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters
4271  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4272  * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network
4273  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4274  *
4275  * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration
4276  *
4277  * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh.
4278  *	The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to
4279  *	set, and which to leave alone.
4280  *
4281  * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS.
4282  *
4283  * @inform_bss: Called by cfg80211 while being informed about new BSS data
4284  *	for every BSS found within the reported data or frame. This is called
4285  *	from within the cfg8011 inform_bss handlers while holding the bss_lock.
4286  *	The data parameter is passed through from drv_data inside
4287  *	struct cfg80211_inform_bss.
4288  *	The new IE data for the BSS is explicitly passed.
4289  *
4290  * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters
4291  *
4292  * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas,
4293  *	as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to
4294  *	join the mesh instead.
4295  *
4296  * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other
4297  *	interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration.
4298  *	If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should
4299  *	be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active.
4300  *
4301  * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given
4302  *	the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done().
4303  *	For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside
4304  *	the scan/scan_done bracket too.
4305  * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall
4306  *	indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done().
4307  *
4308  * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer
4309  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4310  * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer
4311  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4312  * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer
4313  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4314  * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer
4315  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4316  *
4317  * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected,
4318  *	call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code
4319  *	%WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call
4320  *	cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code
4321  *	from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code
4322  *	was received.
4323  *	The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the
4324  *	other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated
4325  *	by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches
4326  *	the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request
4327  *	frame instead of Association Request frame.
4328  *	The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a
4329  *	specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid
4330  *	parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an
4331  *	indication of requesting reassociation.
4332  *	In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming
4333  *	cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to
4334  *	cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4335  * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a
4336  *	BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for
4337  *	subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the
4338  *	Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not
4339  *	request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current
4340  *	BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in
4341  *	changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed.
4342  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4343  * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if
4344  *      connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in
4345  *      case connection was already established (invoked with the
4346  *      wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout().
4347  *
4348  * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call
4349  *	cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due
4350  *	to a merge.
4351  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4352  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS.
4353  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4354  *
4355  * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or
4356  *	MESH mode)
4357  *
4358  * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed;
4359  *	@changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values
4360  *	have changed. The actual parameter values are available in
4361  *	struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed.
4362  *
4363  * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters,
4364  *	the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The
4365  *	wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will
4366  *	always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power
4367  *	(as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.)
4368  * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable;
4369  *	return 0 if successful
4370  *
4371  * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting
4372  *	functions to adjust rfkill hw state
4373  *
4374  * @dump_survey: get site survey information.
4375  *
4376  * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified
4377  *	channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel
4378  *	operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is
4379  *	ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event
4380  *	notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel().
4381  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation.
4382  *	This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on
4383  *	the duration value.
4384  * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame.
4385  * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management
4386  *	frame on another channel
4387  *
4388  * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL
4389  * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be
4390  *	used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally,
4391  *	return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the
4392  *	dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data
4393  *	was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present
4394  *	and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA.
4395  *
4396  * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration
4397  *
4398  * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac
4399  *	devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association
4400  *	RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs.
4401  * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID.
4402  * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs.
4403  * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1
4404  *	allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value.
4405  * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold.
4406  *	After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating
4407  *	the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may
4408  *	need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being
4409  *	disabled.)
4410  * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the
4411  *	connection quality monitor.  An event is to be sent only when the
4412  *	signal level is found to be outside the two values.  The driver should
4413  *	set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented.
4414  *	If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config.
4415  * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error
4416  *	thresholds.
4417  * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan.
4418  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with
4419  *	given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready
4420  *	for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be
4421  *	called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case.
4422  *	The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested
4423  *	stop (when this method returns 0).
4424  *
4425  * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame
4426  *	registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep.
4427  *
4428  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4429  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4430  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4431  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4432  *
4433  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4434  *
4435  * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame.
4436  * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup).
4437  *
4438  * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it
4439  *	later passes to cfg80211_probe_status().
4440  *
4441  * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs.
4442  *
4443  * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface.
4444  *	For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single
4445  *	current monitoring channel.
4446  *
4447  * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device.
4448  * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device.
4449  *
4450  * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode.
4451  *	Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations
4452  *	and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver
4453  *	this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL
4454  *	when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which
4455  *	advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback.
4456  *
4457  * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver.
4458  *
4459  * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC
4460  *	was finished on another phy.
4461  *
4462  * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the
4463  *	driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be
4464  *	used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames.
4465  *
4466  * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability
4467  *	for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the
4468  *	driver can take the most appropriate actions.
4469  * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link
4470  *	reliability. This operation can not fail.
4471  * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters.
4472  *
4473  * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is
4474  *	responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is
4475  *	inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later
4476  *	with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept
4477  *	everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them
4478  *	as soon as possible.
4479  *
4480  * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver
4481  *
4482  * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the
4483  *	given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width
4484  *	changes during the lifetime of the BSS.
4485  *
4486  * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device
4487  *	with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by
4488  *	userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into
4489  *	account.
4490  *	If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure
4491  *	the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return
4492  *	success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake
4493  *	with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later
4494  *	rejected)
4495  * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS
4496  *
4497  * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters
4498  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4499  * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network
4500  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4501  *
4502  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4503  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4504  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP.
4505  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4506  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4507  * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface.
4508  * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface.
4509  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure.
4510  *	On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and
4511  *	it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver
4512  *	should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling
4513  *	cfg80211_free_nan_func().
4514  *	On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the
4515  *	provided @nan_func.
4516  * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function.
4517  * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must
4518  *	be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes);
4519  *	All other parameters must be ignored.
4520  *
4521  * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS
4522  *
4523  * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this
4524  *      function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise.
4525  *
4526  * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake.
4527  *	If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect
4528  *	upon which the driver should clear it.
4529  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4530  * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator.
4531  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4532  *
4533  * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from
4534  *     user space
4535  *
4536  * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL).  The noencrypt parameter
4537  *	tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted.
4538  *
4539  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4540  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4541  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM)
4542  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement
4543  *
4544  * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME
4545  *	but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated
4546  *	DH IE through this interface.
4547  *
4548  * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame
4549  *	and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm.
4550  * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific
4551  *	This callback may sleep.
4552  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the
4553  *	given TIDs. This callback may sleep.
4554  *
4555  * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4556  *
4557  * @color_change: Initiate a color change.
4558  *
4559  * @set_fils_aad: Set FILS AAD data to the AP driver so that the driver can use
4560  *	those to decrypt (Re)Association Request and encrypt (Re)Association
4561  *	Response frame.
4562  *
4563  * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4564  *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4565  *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4566  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4567  *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4568  *	radar channel.
4569  *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4570  *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4571  * @add_link_station: Add a link to a station.
4572  * @mod_link_station: Modify a link of a station.
4573  * @del_link_station: Remove a link of a station.
4574  *
4575  * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames.
4576  * @set_ttlm: set the TID to link mapping.
4577  */
4578 struct cfg80211_ops {
4579 	int	(*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow);
4580 	int	(*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4581 	void	(*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled);
4582 
4583 	struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4584 						  const char *name,
4585 						  unsigned char name_assign_type,
4586 						  enum nl80211_iftype type,
4587 						  struct vif_params *params);
4588 	int	(*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4589 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4590 	int	(*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4591 				       struct net_device *dev,
4592 				       enum nl80211_iftype type,
4593 				       struct vif_params *params);
4594 
4595 	int	(*add_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4596 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4597 				 unsigned int link_id);
4598 	void	(*del_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4599 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4600 				 unsigned int link_id);
4601 
4602 	int	(*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4603 			   int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4604 			   const u8 *mac_addr, struct key_params *params);
4605 	int	(*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4606 			   int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4607 			   const u8 *mac_addr, void *cookie,
4608 			   void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*));
4609 	int	(*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4610 			   int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4611 			   const u8 *mac_addr);
4612 	int	(*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4613 				   struct net_device *netdev, int link_id,
4614 				   u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast);
4615 	int	(*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4616 					struct net_device *netdev, int link_id,
4617 					u8 key_index);
4618 	int	(*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4619 					  struct net_device *netdev,
4620 					  int link_id,
4621 					  u8 key_index);
4622 
4623 	int	(*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4624 			    struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings);
4625 	int	(*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4626 				 struct cfg80211_ap_update *info);
4627 	int	(*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4628 			   unsigned int link_id);
4629 
4630 
4631 	int	(*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4632 			       const u8 *mac,
4633 			       struct station_parameters *params);
4634 	int	(*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4635 			       struct station_del_parameters *params);
4636 	int	(*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4637 				  const u8 *mac,
4638 				  struct station_parameters *params);
4639 	int	(*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4640 			       const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4641 	int	(*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4642 				int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4643 
4644 	int	(*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4645 			       const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4646 	int	(*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4647 			       const u8 *dst);
4648 	int	(*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4649 				  const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4650 	int	(*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4651 			     u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4652 	int	(*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4653 			      int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop,
4654 			      struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4655 	int	(*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4656 			   u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4657 	int	(*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4658 			    int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp,
4659 			    struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4660 	int	(*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4661 				struct net_device *dev,
4662 				struct mesh_config *conf);
4663 	int	(*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4664 				      struct net_device *dev, u32 mask,
4665 				      const struct mesh_config *nconf);
4666 	int	(*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4667 			     const struct mesh_config *conf,
4668 			     const struct mesh_setup *setup);
4669 	int	(*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4670 
4671 	int	(*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4672 			    struct ocb_setup *setup);
4673 	int	(*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4674 
4675 	int	(*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4676 			      struct bss_parameters *params);
4677 
4678 	void	(*inform_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
4679 			      const struct cfg80211_bss_ies *ies, void *data);
4680 
4681 	int	(*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4682 				  struct ieee80211_txq_params *params);
4683 
4684 	int	(*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4685 					     struct net_device *dev,
4686 					     struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
4687 
4688 	int	(*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4689 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4690 
4691 	int	(*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4692 			struct cfg80211_scan_request *request);
4693 	void	(*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4694 
4695 	int	(*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4696 			struct cfg80211_auth_request *req);
4697 	int	(*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4698 			 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req);
4699 	int	(*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4700 			  struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req);
4701 	int	(*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4702 			    struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req);
4703 
4704 	int	(*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4705 			   struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme);
4706 	int	(*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4707 					 struct net_device *dev,
4708 					 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme,
4709 					 u32 changed);
4710 	int	(*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4711 			      u16 reason_code);
4712 
4713 	int	(*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4714 			     struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params);
4715 	int	(*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4716 
4717 	int	(*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4718 				  int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]);
4719 
4720 	int	(*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed);
4721 
4722 	int	(*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4723 				enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm);
4724 	int	(*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4725 				int *dbm);
4726 
4727 	void	(*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4728 
4729 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4730 	int	(*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4731 				void *data, int len);
4732 	int	(*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb,
4733 				 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4734 				 void *data, int len);
4735 #endif
4736 
4737 	int	(*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4738 				    struct net_device *dev,
4739 				    unsigned int link_id,
4740 				    const u8 *peer,
4741 				    const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4742 
4743 	int	(*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4744 			int idx, struct survey_info *info);
4745 
4746 	int	(*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4747 			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4748 	int	(*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4749 			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4750 	int	(*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev);
4751 
4752 	int	(*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4753 				     struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4754 				     struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4755 				     unsigned int duration,
4756 				     u64 *cookie);
4757 	int	(*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4758 					    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4759 					    u64 cookie);
4760 
4761 	int	(*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4762 			   struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params,
4763 			   u64 *cookie);
4764 	int	(*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4765 				       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4766 				       u64 cookie);
4767 
4768 	int	(*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4769 				  bool enabled, int timeout);
4770 
4771 	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4772 				       struct net_device *dev,
4773 				       s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst);
4774 
4775 	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4776 					     struct net_device *dev,
4777 					     s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high);
4778 
4779 	int	(*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4780 				      struct net_device *dev,
4781 				      u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl);
4782 
4783 	void	(*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4784 						   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4785 						   struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd);
4786 
4787 	int	(*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4788 	int	(*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4789 
4790 	int	(*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4791 				struct net_device *dev,
4792 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request);
4793 	int	(*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4794 				   u64 reqid);
4795 
4796 	int	(*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4797 				  struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4798 
4799 	int	(*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4800 			     const u8 *peer, int link_id,
4801 			     u8 action_code, u8 dialog_token, u16 status_code,
4802 			     u32 peer_capability, bool initiator,
4803 			     const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4804 	int	(*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4805 			     const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper);
4806 
4807 	int	(*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4808 				const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie);
4809 
4810 	int	(*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4811 				  struct net_device *dev,
4812 				  u16 noack_map);
4813 
4814 	int	(*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4815 			       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4816 			       unsigned int link_id,
4817 			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4818 
4819 	int	(*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4820 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4821 	void	(*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4822 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4823 
4824 	int	(*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4825 			       const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params);
4826 
4827 	int	(*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4828 					 struct net_device *dev,
4829 					 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4830 					 u32 cac_time_ms);
4831 	void	(*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4832 				struct net_device *dev);
4833 	int	(*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4834 				 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie);
4835 	int	(*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4836 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4837 				    enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol,
4838 				    u16 duration);
4839 	void	(*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4840 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4841 	int	(*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4842 				struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce);
4843 
4844 	int	(*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4845 				  struct net_device *dev,
4846 				  struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params);
4847 
4848 	int     (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4849 			       struct net_device *dev,
4850 			       struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
4851 
4852 	int	(*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4853 				    unsigned int link_id,
4854 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4855 
4856 	int	(*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4857 			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio,
4858 			     u16 admitted_time);
4859 	int	(*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4860 			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer);
4861 
4862 	int	(*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4863 				       struct net_device *dev,
4864 				       const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class,
4865 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4866 	void	(*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4867 					      struct net_device *dev,
4868 					      const u8 *addr);
4869 	int	(*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4870 			     struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4871 	void	(*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4872 	int	(*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4873 				struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4874 	void	(*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4875 			       u64 cookie);
4876 	int	(*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4877 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4878 				   struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf,
4879 				   u32 changes);
4880 
4881 	int	(*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4882 					    struct net_device *dev,
4883 					    const bool enabled);
4884 
4885 	int	(*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4886 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4887 				 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats);
4888 
4889 	int	(*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4890 			   const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf);
4891 	int	(*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4892 			   const u8 *aa);
4893 	int     (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4894 				 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params);
4895 
4896 	int	(*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4897 				   struct net_device *dev,
4898 				   const u8 *buf, size_t len,
4899 				   const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto,
4900 				   const bool noencrypt, int link_id,
4901 				   u64 *cookie);
4902 
4903 	int	(*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4904 				struct net_device *dev,
4905 				struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4906 
4907 	int	(*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4908 			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4909 	void	(*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4910 			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4911 	int	(*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4912 				   struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info);
4913 	int	(*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4914 				   const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4915 	int     (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4916 				  struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4917 	int	(*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4918 				    const u8 *peer, u8 tids);
4919 	int	(*set_sar_specs)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4920 				 struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4921 	int	(*color_change)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4922 				struct net_device *dev,
4923 				struct cfg80211_color_change_settings *params);
4924 	int     (*set_fils_aad)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4925 				struct cfg80211_fils_aad *fils_aad);
4926 	int	(*set_radar_background)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4927 					struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4928 	int	(*add_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4929 				    struct link_station_parameters *params);
4930 	int	(*mod_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4931 				    struct link_station_parameters *params);
4932 	int	(*del_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4933 				    struct link_station_del_parameters *params);
4934 	int	(*set_hw_timestamp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4935 				    struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4936 	int	(*set_ttlm)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4937 			    struct cfg80211_ttlm_params *params);
4938 };
4939 
4940 /*
4941  * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures
4942  * and registration/helper functions
4943  */
4944 
4945 /**
4946  * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags
4947  *
4948  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split
4949  *	 into two, first for legacy bands and second for 6 GHz.
4950  * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this
4951  *	wiphy at all
4952  * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled
4953  *	by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default
4954  *	on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good
4955  *	reason to override the default
4956  * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station
4957  *	on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of
4958  *	supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype.
4959  * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station
4960  * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the
4961  *	control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the
4962  *	control_port_no_encrypt flag.
4963  * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN.
4964  * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing
4965  *	auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH.
4966  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the
4967  *	firmware.
4968  * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP.
4969  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation.
4970  * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z)
4971  *	link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and
4972  *	teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT
4973  *	command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
4974  *	used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation.
4975  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME
4976  * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes
4977  *	when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling
4978  *	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon().
4979  * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device
4980  *	responds to probe-requests in hardware.
4981  * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX.
4982  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call.
4983  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels.
4984  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in
4985  *	beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...).
4986  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys
4987  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO: This is a temporary flag gating the MLO APIs,
4988  *	in order to not have them reachable in normal drivers, until we have
4989  *	complete feature/interface combinations/etc. advertisement. No driver
4990  *	should set this flag for now.
4991  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32: The device supports 32-byte KCK keys.
4992  * @WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER: The device could handle reg notify for
4993  *	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER.
4994  * @WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON: reg_call_notifier() is called if driver
4995  *	set this flag to update channels on beacon hints.
4996  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_NSTR_NONPRIMARY: support connection to non-primary link
4997  *	of an NSTR mobile AP MLD.
4998  * @WIPHY_FLAG_DISABLE_WEXT: disable wireless extensions for this device
4999  */
5000 enum wiphy_flags {
5001 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK		= BIT(0),
5002 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO			= BIT(1),
5003 	WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ		= BIT(2),
5004 	WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK			= BIT(3),
5005 	WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT		= BIT(4),
5006 	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP			= BIT(5),
5007 	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION		= BIT(6),
5008 	WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL	= BIT(7),
5009 	WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN			= BIT(8),
5010 	WIPHY_FLAG_DISABLE_WEXT			= BIT(9),
5011 	WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH			= BIT(10),
5012 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32          = BIT(11),
5013 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_NSTR_NONPRIMARY	= BIT(12),
5014 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM		= BIT(13),
5015 	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD			= BIT(14),
5016 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS		= BIT(15),
5017 	WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP		= BIT(16),
5018 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME			= BIT(17),
5019 	WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS			= BIT(18),
5020 	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD	= BIT(19),
5021 	WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX			= BIT(20),
5022 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL	= BIT(21),
5023 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ		= BIT(22),
5024 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= BIT(23),
5025 	WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER	= BIT(24),
5026 	WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON     = BIT(25),
5027 };
5028 
5029 /**
5030  * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types
5031  * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types
5032  * @types: interface types (bits)
5033  */
5034 struct ieee80211_iface_limit {
5035 	u16 max;
5036 	u16 types;
5037 };
5038 
5039 /**
5040  * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination
5041  *
5042  * With this structure the driver can describe which interface
5043  * combinations it supports concurrently.
5044  *
5045  * Examples:
5046  *
5047  * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total:
5048  *
5049  *    .. code-block:: c
5050  *
5051  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = {
5052  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
5053  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP), },
5054  *	};
5055  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = {
5056  *		.limits = limits1,
5057  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1),
5058  *		.max_interfaces = 2,
5059  *		.beacon_int_infra_match = true,
5060  *	};
5061  *
5062  *
5063  * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total:
5064  *
5065  *    .. code-block:: c
5066  *
5067  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = {
5068  *		{ .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) |
5069  *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), },
5070  *	};
5071  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = {
5072  *		.limits = limits2,
5073  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2),
5074  *		.max_interfaces = 8,
5075  *		.num_different_channels = 1,
5076  *	};
5077  *
5078  *
5079  * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total.
5080  *
5081  *    This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections.
5082  *
5083  *    .. code-block:: c
5084  *
5085  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = {
5086  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
5087  *		{ .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) |
5088  *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), },
5089  *	};
5090  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = {
5091  *		.limits = limits3,
5092  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3),
5093  *		.max_interfaces = 4,
5094  *		.num_different_channels = 2,
5095  *	};
5096  *
5097  */
5098 struct ieee80211_iface_combination {
5099 	/**
5100 	 * @limits:
5101 	 * limits for the given interface types
5102 	 */
5103 	const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits;
5104 
5105 	/**
5106 	 * @num_different_channels:
5107 	 * can use up to this many different channels
5108 	 */
5109 	u32 num_different_channels;
5110 
5111 	/**
5112 	 * @max_interfaces:
5113 	 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group
5114 	 */
5115 	u16 max_interfaces;
5116 
5117 	/**
5118 	 * @n_limits:
5119 	 * number of limitations
5120 	 */
5121 	u8 n_limits;
5122 
5123 	/**
5124 	 * @beacon_int_infra_match:
5125 	 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure
5126 	 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases.
5127 	 */
5128 	bool beacon_int_infra_match;
5129 
5130 	/**
5131 	 * @radar_detect_widths:
5132 	 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection
5133 	 */
5134 	u8 radar_detect_widths;
5135 
5136 	/**
5137 	 * @radar_detect_regions:
5138 	 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection
5139 	 */
5140 	u8 radar_detect_regions;
5141 
5142 	/**
5143 	 * @beacon_int_min_gcd:
5144 	 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals.
5145 	 *
5146 	 * = 0
5147 	 *   all beacon intervals for different interface must be same.
5148 	 * > 0
5149 	 *   any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND
5150 	 *   GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this
5151 	 *   combination must be greater or equal to this value.
5152 	 */
5153 	u32 beacon_int_min_gcd;
5154 };
5155 
5156 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes {
5157 	u16 tx, rx;
5158 };
5159 
5160 /**
5161  * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags
5162  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any"
5163  *	trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and
5164  *	wakes up the host on any activity, for example a
5165  *	received packet that passed filtering; note that the
5166  *	packet should be preserved in that case
5167  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet
5168  *	(see nl80211.h)
5169  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect
5170  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep
5171  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure
5172  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request
5173  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure
5174  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release
5175  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection
5176  */
5177 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags {
5178 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY		= BIT(0),
5179 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT		= BIT(1),
5180 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT		= BIT(2),
5181 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY	= BIT(3),
5182 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE	= BIT(4),
5183 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ	= BIT(5),
5184 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE	= BIT(6),
5185 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE	= BIT(7),
5186 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT		= BIT(8),
5187 };
5188 
5189 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support {
5190 	const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok;
5191 	u32 data_payload_max;
5192 	u32 data_interval_max;
5193 	u32 wake_payload_max;
5194 	bool seq;
5195 };
5196 
5197 /**
5198  * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data
5199  * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags
5200  * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns
5201  *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
5202  * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
5203  * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
5204  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5205  * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect,
5206  *	similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for
5207  *	scheduled scans.
5208  *	See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more
5209  *	details.
5210  * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information
5211  */
5212 struct wiphy_wowlan_support {
5213 	u32 flags;
5214 	int n_patterns;
5215 	int pattern_max_len;
5216 	int pattern_min_len;
5217 	int max_pkt_offset;
5218 	int max_nd_match_sets;
5219 	const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp;
5220 };
5221 
5222 /**
5223  * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data
5224  * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules
5225  * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
5226  * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule
5227  *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
5228  * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
5229  * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
5230  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5231  */
5232 struct wiphy_coalesce_support {
5233 	int n_rules;
5234 	int max_delay;
5235 	int n_patterns;
5236 	int pattern_max_len;
5237 	int pattern_min_len;
5238 	int max_pkt_offset;
5239 };
5240 
5241 /**
5242  * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands
5243  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev
5244  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev
5245  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running
5246  *	(must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV)
5247  */
5248 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags {
5249 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0),
5250 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1),
5251 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2),
5252 };
5253 
5254 /**
5255  * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags
5256  *
5257  * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed
5258  * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed
5259  * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed
5260  *
5261  */
5262 enum wiphy_opmode_flag {
5263 	STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED	= BIT(0),
5264 	STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
5265 	STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED		= BIT(2),
5266 };
5267 
5268 /**
5269  * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information
5270  * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag
5271  * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station
5272  * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station
5273  * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station
5274  */
5275 
5276 struct sta_opmode_info {
5277 	u32 changed;
5278 	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
5279 	enum nl80211_chan_width bw;
5280 	u8 rx_nss;
5281 };
5282 
5283 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA))
5284 
5285 /**
5286  * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition
5287  * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211
5288  * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags
5289  * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the
5290  *	flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data
5291  *	pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all
5292  * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The
5293  *	@storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple
5294  *	dumpit calls.
5295  * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
5296  *	Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the
5297  *	attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command).
5298  * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy
5299  * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and
5300  * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others
5301  * are used with dump requests.
5302  */
5303 struct wiphy_vendor_command {
5304 	struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info;
5305 	u32 flags;
5306 	int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
5307 		    const void *data, int data_len);
5308 	int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
5309 		      struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len,
5310 		      unsigned long *storage);
5311 	const struct nla_policy *policy;
5312 	unsigned int maxattr;
5313 };
5314 
5315 /**
5316  * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type
5317  * @iftype: interface type
5318  * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
5319  *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the
5320  *	802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are
5321  *	in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std
5322  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields.
5323  * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
5324  * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
5325  * @eml_capabilities: EML capabilities (for MLO)
5326  * @mld_capa_and_ops: MLD capabilities and operations (for MLO)
5327  */
5328 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab {
5329 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
5330 	const u8 *extended_capabilities;
5331 	const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask;
5332 	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5333 	u16 eml_capabilities;
5334 	u16 mld_capa_and_ops;
5335 };
5336 
5337 /**
5338  * cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa - lookup interface type extended capability
5339  * @wiphy: the wiphy to look up from
5340  * @type: the interface type to look up
5341  *
5342  * Return: The extended capability for the given interface @type, may be %NULL
5343  */
5344 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *
5345 cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype type);
5346 
5347 /**
5348  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities
5349  * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement
5350  * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement
5351  * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement
5352  * @ftm: FTM measurement data
5353  * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported
5354  * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported
5355  * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported
5356  * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data
5357  * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data
5358  * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble)
5359  * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width)
5360  * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported
5361  *	(set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily
5362  *	forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick)
5363  * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if
5364  *	not limited)
5365  * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported
5366  * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported
5367  */
5368 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities {
5369 	unsigned int max_peers;
5370 	u8 report_ap_tsf:1,
5371 	   randomize_mac_addr:1;
5372 
5373 	struct {
5374 		u32 preambles;
5375 		u32 bandwidths;
5376 		s8 max_bursts_exponent;
5377 		u8 max_ftms_per_burst;
5378 		u8 supported:1,
5379 		   asap:1,
5380 		   non_asap:1,
5381 		   request_lci:1,
5382 		   request_civicloc:1,
5383 		   trigger_based:1,
5384 		   non_trigger_based:1;
5385 	} ftm;
5386 };
5387 
5388 /**
5389  * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm
5390  * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the
5391  * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites.
5392  *
5393  * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types
5394  * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites
5395  * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
5396  */
5397 struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites {
5398 	u16 iftypes_mask;
5399 	const u32 *akm_suites;
5400 	int n_akm_suites;
5401 };
5402 
5403 #define CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS	0xffff
5404 
5405 /**
5406  * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description
5407  * @mtx: mutex for the data (structures) of this device
5408  * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback,
5409  *	note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory()
5410  *	the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL
5411  * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via
5412  *	the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver
5413  *	on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future
5414  *	regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers.
5415  * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss.
5416  * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites
5417  * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites
5418  * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if
5419  *	the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in
5420  *	iftype_akm_suites.
5421  * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
5422  * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type.
5423  *	Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot
5424  *	overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all
5425  *	instances of iftype_akm_suites).
5426  * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm
5427  *	suites are specified separately.
5428  * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit)
5429  * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit)
5430  * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold);
5431  *	-1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used
5432  * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled
5433  * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in
5434  * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device
5435  * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking,
5436  *	set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last
5437  *	four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual
5438  *	variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with
5439  *	interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up.
5440  * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses.
5441  * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer
5442  *	to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used
5443  *	by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to
5444  *	all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle
5445  *	the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses.
5446  * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against
5447  *	unregister hardware
5448  * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>).
5449  *	It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames
5450  * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in
5451  *	/sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev()
5452  *	(see below).
5453  * @wext: wireless extension handlers
5454  * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter)
5455  * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy,
5456  *	must be set by driver
5457  * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not
5458  *	list single interface types.
5459  * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array.
5460  * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not
5461  *	subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW.
5462  * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags
5463  * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see
5464  *	&enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags
5465  * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags.
5466  * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see
5467  *	&enum nl80211_ext_feature_index.
5468  * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it,
5469  *	this variable determines its size
5470  * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in
5471  *	any given scan
5472  * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that
5473  *	the device can run concurrently.
5474  * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan
5475  *	for in any given scheduled scan
5476  * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle
5477  *	when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not
5478  *	supported.
5479  * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can
5480  *	add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not
5481  *	include fixed IEs like supported rates
5482  * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled
5483  *	scans
5484  * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number
5485  *	of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device.
5486  * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a
5487  *	single scan plan supported by the device.
5488  * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single
5489  *	scan plan supported by the device.
5490  * @coverage_class: current coverage class
5491  * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting
5492  * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting
5493  * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device
5494  * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary
5495  *	wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers
5496  * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device
5497  *
5498  * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or
5499  *	transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface
5500  *	type
5501  *
5502  * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
5503  *	configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
5504  *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set.
5505  *
5506  * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
5507  *	configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
5508  *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set.
5509  *
5510  * @probe_resp_offload:
5511  *	 Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading.
5512  *	 See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid
5513  *	 when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set.
5514  *
5515  * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation
5516  *	may request, if implemented.
5517  *
5518  * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information
5519  * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be
5520  *	used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed
5521  *	to the suspend() operation instead.
5522  *
5523  * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
5524  * @ht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden.
5525  *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
5526  * @vht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden.
5527  *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
5528  *
5529  * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must
5530  *	not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection.
5531  *
5532  * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device
5533  *	supports for ACL.
5534  *
5535  * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
5536  *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are
5537  *	the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element")
5538  *	and are in the same format as in the information element. See
5539  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default
5540  *	extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified
5541  *	for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab.
5542  * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
5543  * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
5544  * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type
5545  * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended
5546  *	capabilities are specified separately.
5547  * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information
5548  *
5549  * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware
5550  * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands
5551  * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware
5552  * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events
5553  *
5554  * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode
5555  *	(including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The
5556  *	driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in
5557  *	some cases, but may not always reach.
5558  *
5559  * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons
5560  *	and probe responses.  This value should be set if the driver
5561  *	wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means
5562  *	infinite.
5563  * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported
5564  *	by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the
5565  *	attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr.
5566  *
5567  * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a
5568  *	bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.  For instance, for
5569  *	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
5570  *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
5571  *
5572  * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit
5573  * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit
5574  * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum
5575  *
5576  * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using
5577  *	wake_tx_queue
5578  *
5579  * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP
5580  * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not
5581  *	HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues.
5582  *	@support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect.
5583  *
5584  * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities
5585  *
5586  * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the
5587  *	device has
5588  * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
5589  *	supported by the driver for each vif
5590  * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
5591  *	supported by the driver for each peer
5592  * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for
5593  *	long/short retry configuration
5594  *
5595  * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for
5596  *	configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and
5597  *	%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes
5598  * @sar_capa: SAR control capabilities
5599  * @rfkill: a pointer to the rfkill structure
5600  *
5601  * @mbssid_max_interfaces: maximum number of interfaces supported by the driver
5602  *	in a multiple BSSID set. This field must be set to a non-zero value
5603  *	by the driver to advertise MBSSID support.
5604  * @ema_max_profile_periodicity: maximum profile periodicity supported by
5605  *	the driver. Setting this field to a non-zero value indicates that the
5606  *	driver supports enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP).
5607  * @max_num_akm_suites: maximum number of AKM suites allowed for
5608  *	configuration through %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
5609  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_AP. Set to NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES if not set by
5610  *	driver. If set by driver minimum allowed value is
5611  *	NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES in order to avoid compatibility issues with
5612  *	legacy userspace and maximum allowed value is
5613  *	CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES.
5614  *
5615  * @hw_timestamp_max_peers: maximum number of peers that the driver supports
5616  *	enabling HW timestamping for concurrently. Setting this field to a
5617  *	non-zero value indicates that the driver supports HW timestamping.
5618  *	A value of %CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS indicates the driver
5619  *	supports enabling HW timestamping for all peers (i.e. no need to
5620  *	specify a mac address).
5621  */
5622 struct wiphy {
5623 	struct mutex mtx;
5624 
5625 	/* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */
5626 
5627 	u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN];
5628 	u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN];
5629 
5630 	struct mac_address *addresses;
5631 
5632 	const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes;
5633 
5634 	const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations;
5635 	int n_iface_combinations;
5636 	u16 software_iftypes;
5637 
5638 	u16 n_addresses;
5639 
5640 	/* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */
5641 	u16 interface_modes;
5642 
5643 	u16 max_acl_mac_addrs;
5644 
5645 	u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features;
5646 	u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)];
5647 
5648 	u32 ap_sme_capa;
5649 
5650 	enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type;
5651 
5652 	int bss_priv_size;
5653 	u8 max_scan_ssids;
5654 	u8 max_sched_scan_reqs;
5655 	u8 max_sched_scan_ssids;
5656 	u8 max_match_sets;
5657 	u16 max_scan_ie_len;
5658 	u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len;
5659 	u32 max_sched_scan_plans;
5660 	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval;
5661 	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations;
5662 
5663 	int n_cipher_suites;
5664 	const u32 *cipher_suites;
5665 
5666 	int n_akm_suites;
5667 	const u32 *akm_suites;
5668 
5669 	const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites;
5670 	unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites;
5671 
5672 	u8 retry_short;
5673 	u8 retry_long;
5674 	u32 frag_threshold;
5675 	u32 rts_threshold;
5676 	u8 coverage_class;
5677 
5678 	char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN];
5679 	u32 hw_version;
5680 
5681 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
5682 	const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan;
5683 	struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config;
5684 #endif
5685 
5686 	u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration;
5687 
5688 	u8 max_num_pmkids;
5689 
5690 	u32 available_antennas_tx;
5691 	u32 available_antennas_rx;
5692 
5693 	u32 probe_resp_offload;
5694 
5695 	const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask;
5696 	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5697 
5698 	const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab;
5699 	unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab;
5700 
5701 	const void *privid;
5702 
5703 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
5704 
5705 	void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5706 			     struct regulatory_request *request);
5707 
5708 	/* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */
5709 
5710 	const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd;
5711 
5712 	struct device dev;
5713 
5714 	bool registered;
5715 
5716 	struct dentry *debugfsdir;
5717 
5718 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask;
5719 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask;
5720 
5721 	struct list_head wdev_list;
5722 
5723 	possible_net_t _net;
5724 
5725 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
5726 	const struct iw_handler_def *wext;
5727 #endif
5728 
5729 	const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce;
5730 
5731 	const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands;
5732 	const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events;
5733 	int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events;
5734 
5735 	u16 max_ap_assoc_sta;
5736 
5737 	u8 max_num_csa_counters;
5738 
5739 	u32 bss_select_support;
5740 
5741 	u8 nan_supported_bands;
5742 
5743 	u32 txq_limit;
5744 	u32 txq_memory_limit;
5745 	u32 txq_quantum;
5746 
5747 	unsigned long tx_queue_len;
5748 
5749 	u8 support_mbssid:1,
5750 	   support_only_he_mbssid:1;
5751 
5752 	const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa;
5753 
5754 	struct {
5755 		u64 peer, vif;
5756 		u8 max_retry;
5757 	} tid_config_support;
5758 
5759 	u8 max_data_retry_count;
5760 
5761 	const struct cfg80211_sar_capa *sar_capa;
5762 
5763 	struct rfkill *rfkill;
5764 
5765 	u8 mbssid_max_interfaces;
5766 	u8 ema_max_profile_periodicity;
5767 	u16 max_num_akm_suites;
5768 
5769 	u16 hw_timestamp_max_peers;
5770 
5771 	char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN);
5772 };
5773 
5774 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5775 {
5776 	return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net);
5777 }
5778 
5779 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net)
5780 {
5781 	write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net);
5782 }
5783 
5784 /**
5785  * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy
5786  *
5787  * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return
5788  * Return: The priv of @wiphy.
5789  */
5790 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5791 {
5792 	BUG_ON(!wiphy);
5793 	return &wiphy->priv;
5794 }
5795 
5796 /**
5797  * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv
5798  *
5799  * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv
5800  * Return: The wiphy of @priv.
5801  */
5802 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv)
5803 {
5804 	BUG_ON(!priv);
5805 	return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv);
5806 }
5807 
5808 /**
5809  * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy
5810  *
5811  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind
5812  * @dev: The device to parent it to
5813  */
5814 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev)
5815 {
5816 	wiphy->dev.parent = dev;
5817 }
5818 
5819 /**
5820  * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer
5821  *
5822  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up
5823  * Return: The dev of @wiphy.
5824  */
5825 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5826 {
5827 	return wiphy->dev.parent;
5828 }
5829 
5830 /**
5831  * wiphy_name - get wiphy name
5832  *
5833  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return
5834  * Return: The name of @wiphy.
5835  */
5836 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy)
5837 {
5838 	return dev_name(&wiphy->dev);
5839 }
5840 
5841 /**
5842  * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5843  *
5844  * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5845  * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5846  * @requested_name: Request a particular name.
5847  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming.
5848  *
5849  * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5850  * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5851  *
5852  * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5853  * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5854  */
5855 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv,
5856 			   const char *requested_name);
5857 
5858 /**
5859  * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5860  *
5861  * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5862  * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5863  *
5864  * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5865  * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5866  *
5867  * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5868  * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5869  */
5870 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops,
5871 				      int sizeof_priv)
5872 {
5873 	return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL);
5874 }
5875 
5876 /**
5877  * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211
5878  *
5879  * @wiphy: The wiphy to register.
5880  *
5881  * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code.
5882  */
5883 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5884 
5885 /* this is a define for better error reporting (file/line) */
5886 #define lockdep_assert_wiphy(wiphy) lockdep_assert_held(&(wiphy)->mtx)
5887 
5888 /**
5889  * rcu_dereference_wiphy - rcu_dereference with debug checking
5890  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
5891  * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
5892  *
5893  * Do an rcu_dereference(p), but check caller either holds rcu_read_lock()
5894  * or RTNL. Note: Please prefer wiphy_dereference() or rcu_dereference().
5895  */
5896 #define rcu_dereference_wiphy(wiphy, p)				\
5897         rcu_dereference_check(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
5898 
5899 /**
5900  * wiphy_dereference - fetch RCU pointer when updates are prevented by wiphy mtx
5901  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
5902  * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
5903  *
5904  * Return the value of the specified RCU-protected pointer, but omit the
5905  * READ_ONCE(), because caller holds the wiphy mutex used for updates.
5906  */
5907 #define wiphy_dereference(wiphy, p)				\
5908         rcu_dereference_protected(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
5909 
5910 /**
5911  * get_wiphy_regdom - get custom regdomain for the given wiphy
5912  * @wiphy: the wiphy to get the regdomain from
5913  *
5914  * Context: Requires any of RTNL, wiphy mutex or RCU protection.
5915  *
5916  * Return: pointer to the regulatory domain associated with the wiphy
5917  */
5918 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *get_wiphy_regdom(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5919 
5920 /**
5921  * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211
5922  *
5923  * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister.
5924  *
5925  * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv
5926  * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding
5927  * request that is being handled.
5928  */
5929 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5930 
5931 /**
5932  * wiphy_free - free wiphy
5933  *
5934  * @wiphy: The wiphy to free
5935  */
5936 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5937 
5938 /* internal structs */
5939 struct cfg80211_conn;
5940 struct cfg80211_internal_bss;
5941 struct cfg80211_cached_keys;
5942 struct cfg80211_cqm_config;
5943 
5944 /**
5945  * wiphy_lock - lock the wiphy
5946  * @wiphy: the wiphy to lock
5947  *
5948  * This is needed around registering and unregistering netdevs that
5949  * aren't created through cfg80211 calls, since that requires locking
5950  * in cfg80211 when the notifiers is called, but that cannot
5951  * differentiate which way it's called.
5952  *
5953  * It can also be used by drivers for their own purposes.
5954  *
5955  * When cfg80211 ops are called, the wiphy is already locked.
5956  *
5957  * Note that this makes sure that no workers that have been queued
5958  * with wiphy_queue_work() are running.
5959  */
5960 static inline void wiphy_lock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5961 	__acquires(&wiphy->mtx)
5962 {
5963 	mutex_lock(&wiphy->mtx);
5964 	__acquire(&wiphy->mtx);
5965 }
5966 
5967 /**
5968  * wiphy_unlock - unlock the wiphy again
5969  * @wiphy: the wiphy to unlock
5970  */
5971 static inline void wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5972 	__releases(&wiphy->mtx)
5973 {
5974 	__release(&wiphy->mtx);
5975 	mutex_unlock(&wiphy->mtx);
5976 }
5977 
5978 struct wiphy_work;
5979 typedef void (*wiphy_work_func_t)(struct wiphy *, struct wiphy_work *);
5980 
5981 struct wiphy_work {
5982 	struct list_head entry;
5983 	wiphy_work_func_t func;
5984 };
5985 
5986 static inline void wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work *work,
5987 				   wiphy_work_func_t func)
5988 {
5989 	INIT_LIST_HEAD(&work->entry);
5990 	work->func = func;
5991 }
5992 
5993 /**
5994  * wiphy_work_queue - queue work for the wiphy
5995  * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for
5996  * @work: the work item
5997  *
5998  * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work
5999  * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be
6000  * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running
6001  * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can
6002  * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires
6003  * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock().
6004  */
6005 void wiphy_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
6006 
6007 /**
6008  * wiphy_work_cancel - cancel previously queued work
6009  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6010  * @work: the work to cancel
6011  *
6012  * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being
6013  * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6014  */
6015 void wiphy_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
6016 
6017 /**
6018  * wiphy_work_flush - flush previously queued work
6019  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6020  * @work: the work to flush, this can be %NULL to flush all work
6021  *
6022  * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called
6023  * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6024  */
6025 void wiphy_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
6026 
6027 struct wiphy_delayed_work {
6028 	struct wiphy_work work;
6029 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
6030 	struct timer_list timer;
6031 };
6032 
6033 void wiphy_delayed_work_timer(struct timer_list *t);
6034 
6035 static inline void wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork,
6036 					   wiphy_work_func_t func)
6037 {
6038 	timer_setup(&dwork->timer, wiphy_delayed_work_timer, 0);
6039 	wiphy_work_init(&dwork->work, func);
6040 }
6041 
6042 /**
6043  * wiphy_delayed_work_queue - queue delayed work for the wiphy
6044  * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for
6045  * @dwork: the delayable worker
6046  * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6047  *
6048  * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work
6049  * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be
6050  * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running
6051  * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can
6052  * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires
6053  * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock().
6054  */
6055 void wiphy_delayed_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6056 			      struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork,
6057 			      unsigned long delay);
6058 
6059 /**
6060  * wiphy_delayed_work_cancel - cancel previously queued delayed work
6061  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6062  * @dwork: the delayed work to cancel
6063  *
6064  * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being
6065  * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6066  */
6067 void wiphy_delayed_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6068 			       struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
6069 
6070 /**
6071  * wiphy_delayed_work_flush - flush previously queued delayed work
6072  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6073  * @dwork: the delayed work to flush
6074  *
6075  * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called
6076  * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6077  */
6078 void wiphy_delayed_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6079 			      struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
6080 
6081 /**
6082  * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state
6083  *
6084  * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver
6085  * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this
6086  * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.)
6087  * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will
6088  * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device,
6089  * however, drivers must lock the wiphy before registering or
6090  * unregistering netdevs if they pre-create any netdevs (in ops
6091  * called from cfg80211, the wiphy is already locked.)
6092  *
6093  * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver
6094  * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as
6095  * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be
6096  * allocated outside of callback operations that return it.
6097  *
6098  * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description
6099  * @iftype: interface type
6100  * @registered: is this wdev already registered with cfg80211
6101  * @registering: indicates we're doing registration under wiphy lock
6102  *	for the notifier
6103  * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces
6104  * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL
6105  * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this
6106  *	wireless device if it has no netdev
6107  * @u: union containing data specific to @iftype
6108  * @connected: indicates if connected or not (STA mode)
6109  * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code
6110  * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling
6111  * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data
6112  * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data
6113  * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association
6114  * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements
6115  * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID
6116  * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID
6117  * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index
6118  * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index
6119  * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation
6120  * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity
6121  * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be
6122  *	set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the
6123  *	netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update
6124  *	by cfg80211 on change_interface
6125  * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames
6126  * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated,
6127  *	need to propagate the update to the driver
6128  * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL
6129  * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g.
6130  *	the P2P Device.
6131  * @cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been started
6132  * @cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
6133  * @cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms
6134  * @ps: powersave mode is enabled
6135  * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout
6136  * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application
6137  *	registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode)
6138  * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data
6139  * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established
6140  * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type
6141  * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID
6142  * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work
6143  * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect
6144  * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing
6145  * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list
6146  * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID
6147  * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away
6148  * @cqm_rssi_work: (private) CQM RSSI reporting work
6149  * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state
6150  * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests
6151  * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock
6152  * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work
6153  * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last
6154  *	unprotected beacon report
6155  * @links: array of %IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS elements containing @addr
6156  *	@ap and @client for each link
6157  * @valid_links: bitmap describing what elements of @links are valid
6158  */
6159 struct wireless_dev {
6160 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
6161 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
6162 
6163 	/* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */
6164 	struct list_head list;
6165 	struct net_device *netdev;
6166 
6167 	u32 identifier;
6168 
6169 	struct list_head mgmt_registrations;
6170 	u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1;
6171 
6172 	bool use_4addr, is_running, registered, registering;
6173 
6174 	u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16));
6175 
6176 	/* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */
6177 	struct cfg80211_conn *conn;
6178 	struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys;
6179 	enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type;
6180 	u32 conn_owner_nlportid;
6181 
6182 	struct work_struct disconnect_wk;
6183 	u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6184 
6185 	struct list_head event_list;
6186 	spinlock_t event_lock;
6187 
6188 	u8 connected:1;
6189 
6190 	bool ps;
6191 	int ps_timeout;
6192 
6193 	u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid;
6194 
6195 	u32 owner_nlportid;
6196 	bool nl_owner_dead;
6197 
6198 	/* FIXME: need to rework radar detection for MLO */
6199 	bool cac_started;
6200 	unsigned long cac_start_time;
6201 	unsigned int cac_time_ms;
6202 
6203 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
6204 	/* wext data */
6205 	struct {
6206 		struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss;
6207 		struct cfg80211_connect_params connect;
6208 		struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys;
6209 		const u8 *ie;
6210 		size_t ie_len;
6211 		u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6212 		u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6213 		u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6214 		s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key;
6215 		bool prev_bssid_valid;
6216 	} wext;
6217 #endif
6218 
6219 	struct wiphy_work cqm_rssi_work;
6220 	struct cfg80211_cqm_config __rcu *cqm_config;
6221 
6222 	struct list_head pmsr_list;
6223 	spinlock_t pmsr_lock;
6224 	struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk;
6225 
6226 	unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported;
6227 
6228 	union {
6229 		struct {
6230 			u8 connected_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
6231 			u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6232 			u8 ssid_len;
6233 		} client;
6234 		struct {
6235 			int beacon_interval;
6236 			struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
6237 			struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6238 			u8 id[IEEE80211_MAX_MESH_ID_LEN];
6239 			u8 id_len, id_up_len;
6240 		} mesh;
6241 		struct {
6242 			struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
6243 			u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6244 			u8 ssid_len;
6245 		} ap;
6246 		struct {
6247 			struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss;
6248 			struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6249 			int beacon_interval;
6250 			u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6251 			u8 ssid_len;
6252 		} ibss;
6253 		struct {
6254 			struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6255 		} ocb;
6256 	} u;
6257 
6258 	struct {
6259 		u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
6260 		union {
6261 			struct {
6262 				unsigned int beacon_interval;
6263 				struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6264 			} ap;
6265 			struct {
6266 				struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss;
6267 			} client;
6268 		};
6269 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
6270 	u16 valid_links;
6271 };
6272 
6273 static inline const u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6274 {
6275 	if (wdev->netdev)
6276 		return wdev->netdev->dev_addr;
6277 	return wdev->address;
6278 }
6279 
6280 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6281 {
6282 	if (wdev->netdev)
6283 		return netif_running(wdev->netdev);
6284 	return wdev->is_running;
6285 }
6286 
6287 /**
6288  * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev
6289  *
6290  * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return
6291  * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev.
6292  */
6293 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6294 {
6295 	BUG_ON(!wdev);
6296 	return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy);
6297 }
6298 
6299 /**
6300  * wdev_chandef - return chandef pointer from wireless_dev
6301  * @wdev: the wdev
6302  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO
6303  *
6304  * Return: The chandef depending on the mode, or %NULL.
6305  */
6306 struct cfg80211_chan_def *wdev_chandef(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6307 				       unsigned int link_id);
6308 
6309 static inline void WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6310 					unsigned int link_id)
6311 {
6312 	WARN_ON(link_id && !wdev->valid_links);
6313 	WARN_ON(wdev->valid_links &&
6314 		!(wdev->valid_links & BIT(link_id)));
6315 }
6316 
6317 #define for_each_valid_link(link_info, link_id)			\
6318 	for (link_id = 0;					\
6319 	     link_id < ((link_info)->valid_links ?		\
6320 			ARRAY_SIZE((link_info)->links) : 1);	\
6321 	     link_id++)						\
6322 		if (!(link_info)->valid_links ||		\
6323 		    ((link_info)->valid_links & BIT(link_id)))
6324 
6325 /**
6326  * DOC: Utility functions
6327  *
6328  * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful.
6329  */
6330 
6331 /**
6332  * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel
6333  *
6334  * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel
6335  * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel
6336  * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b
6337  */
6338 static inline bool
6339 ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a,
6340 			struct ieee80211_channel *b)
6341 {
6342 	return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq &&
6343 		a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset);
6344 }
6345 
6346 /**
6347  * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz
6348  * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert
6349  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz)
6350  */
6351 static inline u32
6352 ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
6353 {
6354 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset;
6355 }
6356 
6357 /**
6358  * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan
6359  *
6360  * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ
6361  * @chan: channel
6362  * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq
6363  */
6364 enum nl80211_chan_width
6365 ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
6366 
6367 /**
6368  * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency
6369  * @chan: channel number
6370  * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
6371  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
6372  */
6373 u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band);
6374 
6375 /**
6376  * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency
6377  * @chan: channel number
6378  * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
6379  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
6380  */
6381 static inline int
6382 ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band)
6383 {
6384 	return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band));
6385 }
6386 
6387 /**
6388  * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
6389  * @freq: center frequency in KHz
6390  * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
6391  */
6392 int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq);
6393 
6394 /**
6395  * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
6396  * @freq: center frequency in MHz
6397  * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
6398  */
6399 static inline int
6400 ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)
6401 {
6402 	return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
6403 }
6404 
6405 /**
6406  * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified
6407  * frequency
6408  * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
6409  * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel
6410  * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
6411  */
6412 struct ieee80211_channel *
6413 ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq);
6414 
6415 /**
6416  * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency
6417  *
6418  * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
6419  * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel
6420  * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
6421  */
6422 static inline struct ieee80211_channel *
6423 ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq)
6424 {
6425 	return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
6426 }
6427 
6428 /**
6429  * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC
6430  * @chan: control channel to check
6431  *
6432  * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in
6433  * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3
6434  *
6435  * Return: %true if channel is a PSC, %false otherwise
6436  */
6437 static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
6438 {
6439 	if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ)
6440 		return false;
6441 
6442 	return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5;
6443 }
6444 
6445 /**
6446  * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate
6447  *
6448  * @sband: the band to look for rates in
6449  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates
6450  * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate
6451  *
6452  * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that
6453  * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map,
6454  * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of
6455  * rates in the band's bitrate table.
6456  */
6457 const struct ieee80211_rate *
6458 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6459 			    u32 basic_rates, int bitrate);
6460 
6461 /**
6462  * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band
6463  * @sband: the band to look for rates in
6464  *
6465  * Return: a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given band, bits
6466  * are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array.
6467  */
6468 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband);
6469 
6470 /*
6471  * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support
6472  *
6473  * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c
6474  * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst
6475  */
6476 
6477 struct radiotap_align_size {
6478 	uint8_t align:4, size:4;
6479 };
6480 
6481 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace {
6482 	const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size;
6483 	int n_bits;
6484 	uint32_t oui;
6485 	uint8_t subns;
6486 };
6487 
6488 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces {
6489 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns;
6490 	int n_ns;
6491 };
6492 
6493 /**
6494  * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args
6495  * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call
6496  *	to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next()
6497  * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each
6498  *	call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after
6499  *	ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to
6500  *	the beginning of the actual data portion
6501  * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience
6502  * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition
6503  *	(or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown)
6504  * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default
6505  *	radiotap namespace or not
6506  *
6507  * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through
6508  * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering
6509  * @_arg_index: next argument index
6510  * @_arg: next argument pointer
6511  * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32
6512  * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present
6513  * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions
6514  * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data
6515  * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the
6516  *	next bitmap word
6517  *
6518  * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore
6519  * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally.
6520  */
6521 
6522 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator {
6523 	struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader;
6524 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns;
6525 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace;
6526 
6527 	unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data;
6528 	__le32 *_next_bitmap;
6529 
6530 	unsigned char *this_arg;
6531 	int this_arg_index;
6532 	int this_arg_size;
6533 
6534 	int is_radiotap_ns;
6535 
6536 	int _max_length;
6537 	int _arg_index;
6538 	uint32_t _bitmap_shifter;
6539 	int _reset_on_ext;
6540 };
6541 
6542 int
6543 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator,
6544 				 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header,
6545 				 int max_length,
6546 				 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns);
6547 
6548 int
6549 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator);
6550 
6551 
6552 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6];
6553 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6];
6554 
6555 /**
6556  * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data
6557  *
6558  * @skb: the frame
6559  *
6560  * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function
6561  * returns the 802.11 header length.
6562  *
6563  * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption
6564  * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid
6565  * 802.11 header.
6566  */
6567 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb);
6568 
6569 /**
6570  * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control
6571  * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format
6572  * Return: The header length in bytes.
6573  */
6574 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc);
6575 
6576 /**
6577  * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length
6578  * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field
6579  *	(first byte) will be accessed
6580  * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at
6581  * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present.
6582  */
6583 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr);
6584 
6585 /**
6586  * DOC: Data path helpers
6587  *
6588  * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers
6589  * functions that help implement the data path for devices
6590  * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device.
6591  */
6592 
6593 /**
6594  * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
6595  * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
6596  * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead
6597  *	of it being pushed into the SKB
6598  * @addr: the device MAC address
6599  * @iftype: the virtual interface type
6600  * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header
6601  * @is_amsdu: true if the 802.11 header is A-MSDU
6602  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6603  */
6604 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr,
6605 				  const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
6606 				  u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu);
6607 
6608 /**
6609  * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
6610  * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
6611  * @addr: the device MAC address
6612  * @iftype: the virtual interface type
6613  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6614  */
6615 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr,
6616 					 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
6617 {
6618 	return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false);
6619 }
6620 
6621 /**
6622  * ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu - check if subframe lengths of an A-MSDU are valid
6623  *
6624  * This is used to detect non-standard A-MSDU frames, e.g. the ones generated
6625  * by ath10k and ath11k, where the subframe length includes the length of the
6626  * mesh control field.
6627  *
6628  * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
6629  * @mesh_hdr: the type of mesh header to test
6630  *	0: non-mesh A-MSDU length field
6631  *	1: big-endian mesh A-MSDU length field
6632  *	2: little-endian mesh A-MSDU length field
6633  * Returns: true if subframe header lengths are valid for the @mesh_hdr mode
6634  */
6635 bool ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 mesh_hdr);
6636 
6637 /**
6638  * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame
6639  *
6640  * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames.
6641  * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully
6642  * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function.
6643  *
6644  * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
6645  * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and
6646  *	initialized by the caller.
6647  * @addr: The device MAC address.
6648  * @iftype: The device interface type.
6649  * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list.
6650  * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
6651  * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
6652  * @mesh_control: see mesh_hdr in ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu
6653  */
6654 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list,
6655 			      const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
6656 			      const unsigned int extra_headroom,
6657 			      const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa,
6658 			      u8 mesh_control);
6659 
6660 /**
6661  * ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto - get RFC1042 or bridge tunnel encap protocol
6662  *
6663  * Check for RFC1042 or bridge tunnel header and fetch the encapsulated
6664  * protocol.
6665  *
6666  * @hdr: pointer to the MSDU payload
6667  * @proto: destination pointer to store the protocol
6668  * Return: true if encapsulation was found
6669  */
6670 bool ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto(const void *hdr, __be16 *proto);
6671 
6672 /**
6673  * ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr - strip mesh header from converted 802.3 frames
6674  *
6675  * Strip the mesh header, which was left in by ieee80211_data_to_8023 as part
6676  * of the MSDU data. Also move any source/destination addresses from the mesh
6677  * header to the ethernet header (if present).
6678  *
6679  * @skb: The 802.3 frame with embedded mesh header
6680  *
6681  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6682  */
6683 int ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr(struct sk_buff *skb);
6684 
6685 /**
6686  * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame
6687  * @skb: the data frame
6688  * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use
6689  * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag.
6690  */
6691 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb,
6692 				    struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
6693 
6694 /**
6695  * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data
6696  *
6697  * @eid: element ID
6698  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6699  * @len: length of data
6700  * @match: byte array to match
6701  * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
6702  * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match.
6703  *	Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers
6704  *	the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take
6705  *	the data portion instead.
6706  *
6707  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6708  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6709  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6710  * requested element struct.
6711  *
6712  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6713  * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
6714  * byte array to match.
6715  */
6716 const struct element *
6717 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
6718 			 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
6719 			 unsigned int match_offset);
6720 
6721 /**
6722  * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data
6723  *
6724  * @eid: element ID
6725  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6726  * @len: length of data
6727  * @match: byte array to match
6728  * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
6729  * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match.
6730  *	If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero.
6731  *	Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first
6732  *	byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and
6733  *	the second byte is the IE length.
6734  *
6735  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6736  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6737  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first
6738  * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
6739  * element ID.
6740  *
6741  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6742  * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
6743  * byte array to match.
6744  */
6745 static inline const u8 *
6746 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
6747 		       const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
6748 		       unsigned int match_offset)
6749 {
6750 	/* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is
6751 	 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well.
6752 	 */
6753 	if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) ||
6754 		    (!match_len && match_offset)))
6755 		return NULL;
6756 
6757 	return (const void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len,
6758 						      match, match_len,
6759 						      match_offset ?
6760 							match_offset - 2 : 0);
6761 }
6762 
6763 /**
6764  * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data
6765  *
6766  * @eid: element ID
6767  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6768  * @len: length of data
6769  *
6770  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6771  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6772  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6773  * requested element struct.
6774  *
6775  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6776  * having to fit into the given data.
6777  */
6778 static inline const struct element *
6779 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6780 {
6781 	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
6782 }
6783 
6784 /**
6785  * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data
6786  *
6787  * @eid: element ID
6788  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6789  * @len: length of data
6790  *
6791  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6792  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6793  * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
6794  * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
6795  *
6796  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6797  * having to fit into the given data.
6798  */
6799 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6800 {
6801 	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
6802 }
6803 
6804 /**
6805  * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data
6806  *
6807  * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
6808  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6809  * @len: length of data
6810  *
6811  * Return: %NULL if the extended element could not be found or if
6812  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6813  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6814  * requested element struct.
6815  *
6816  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6817  * having to fit into the given data.
6818  */
6819 static inline const struct element *
6820 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6821 {
6822 	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
6823 					&ext_eid, 1, 0);
6824 }
6825 
6826 /**
6827  * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data
6828  *
6829  * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
6830  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6831  * @len: length of data
6832  *
6833  * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if
6834  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6835  * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
6836  * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
6837  *
6838  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6839  * having to fit into the given data.
6840  */
6841 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6842 {
6843 	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
6844 				      &ext_eid, 1, 2);
6845 }
6846 
6847 /**
6848  * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data
6849  *
6850  * @oui: vendor OUI
6851  * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
6852  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6853  * @len: length of data
6854  *
6855  * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
6856  * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise
6857  * return the element structure for the requested element.
6858  *
6859  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
6860  * the given data.
6861  */
6862 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
6863 						const u8 *ies,
6864 						unsigned int len);
6865 
6866 /**
6867  * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data
6868  *
6869  * @oui: vendor OUI
6870  * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
6871  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6872  * @len: length of data
6873  *
6874  * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
6875  * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to
6876  * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
6877  * element ID.
6878  *
6879  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
6880  * the given data.
6881  */
6882 static inline const u8 *
6883 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
6884 			const u8 *ies, unsigned int len)
6885 {
6886 	return (const void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len);
6887 }
6888 
6889 /**
6890  * enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret - reduced neighbor report iteration state
6891  * @RNR_ITER_CONTINUE: continue iterating with the next entry
6892  * @RNR_ITER_BREAK: break iteration and return success
6893  * @RNR_ITER_ERROR: break iteration and return error
6894  */
6895 enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret {
6896 	RNR_ITER_CONTINUE,
6897 	RNR_ITER_BREAK,
6898 	RNR_ITER_ERROR,
6899 };
6900 
6901 /**
6902  * cfg80211_iter_rnr - iterate reduced neighbor report entries
6903  * @elems: the frame elements to iterate RNR elements and then
6904  *	their entries in
6905  * @elems_len: length of the elements
6906  * @iter: iteration function, see also &enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret
6907  *	for the return value
6908  * @iter_data: additional data passed to the iteration function
6909  * Return: %true on success (after successfully iterating all entries
6910  *	or if the iteration function returned %RNR_ITER_BREAK),
6911  *	%false on error (iteration function returned %RNR_ITER_ERROR
6912  *	or elements were malformed.)
6913  */
6914 bool cfg80211_iter_rnr(const u8 *elems, size_t elems_len,
6915 		       enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret
6916 		       (*iter)(void *data, u8 type,
6917 			       const struct ieee80211_neighbor_ap_info *info,
6918 			       const u8 *tbtt_info, u8 tbtt_info_len),
6919 		       void *iter_data);
6920 
6921 /**
6922  * cfg80211_defragment_element - Defrag the given element data into a buffer
6923  *
6924  * @elem: the element to defragment
6925  * @ies: elements where @elem is contained
6926  * @ieslen: length of @ies
6927  * @data: buffer to store element data, or %NULL to just determine size
6928  * @data_len: length of @data, or 0
6929  * @frag_id: the element ID of fragments
6930  *
6931  * Return: length of @data, or -EINVAL on error
6932  *
6933  * Copy out all data from an element that may be fragmented into @data, while
6934  * skipping all headers.
6935  *
6936  * The function uses memmove() internally. It is acceptable to defragment an
6937  * element in-place.
6938  */
6939 ssize_t cfg80211_defragment_element(const struct element *elem, const u8 *ies,
6940 				    size_t ieslen, u8 *data, size_t data_len,
6941 				    u8 frag_id);
6942 
6943 /**
6944  * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame
6945  *
6946  * @dev: network device
6947  * @addr: STA MAC address
6948  *
6949  * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge
6950  * devices upon STA association.
6951  */
6952 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
6953 
6954 /**
6955  * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure
6956  *
6957  * TODO
6958  */
6959 
6960 /**
6961  * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain
6962  * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting
6963  *	conflicts)
6964  * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain
6965  *	should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you
6966  *	set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted
6967  *	alpha2.
6968  *
6969  * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core
6970  * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by
6971  * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory
6972  * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain.
6973  * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried
6974  * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country.
6975  *
6976  * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call.
6977  * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(),
6978  * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw().
6979  *
6980  * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
6981  * an -ENOMEM.
6982  *
6983  * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM.
6984  */
6985 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2);
6986 
6987 /**
6988  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers
6989  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6990  * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
6991  *
6992  * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they
6993  * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more
6994  * information.
6995  *
6996  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
6997  */
6998 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6999 			      struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
7000 
7001 /**
7002  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync - set regdom for self-managed drivers
7003  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
7004  * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
7005  *
7006  * This functions requires the RTNL and the wiphy mutex to be held and
7007  * applies the new regdomain synchronously to this wiphy. For more details
7008  * see regulatory_set_wiphy_regd().
7009  *
7010  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
7011  */
7012 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7013 				   struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
7014 
7015 /**
7016  * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain
7017  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
7018  * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy
7019  *
7020  * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply
7021  * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory
7022  * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The
7023  * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous
7024  * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a
7025  * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled.
7026  * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag
7027  * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy
7028  * that called this helper.
7029  */
7030 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7031 				   const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd);
7032 
7033 /**
7034  * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency
7035  * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for
7036  * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for
7037  *
7038  * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on
7039  * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain
7040  * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received
7041  * and processed already.
7042  *
7043  * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule
7044  * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to
7045  * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return
7046  * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even
7047  * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band.
7048  * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is
7049  * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific.
7050  */
7051 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7052 					       u32 center_freq);
7053 
7054 /**
7055  * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name
7056  * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator
7057  *
7058  * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a
7059  * proper string representation.
7060  *
7061  * Return: pointer to string representation of the initiator
7062  */
7063 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator);
7064 
7065 /**
7066  * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom
7067  * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked.
7068  *
7069  * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI).
7070  *
7071  * Return: %true if allowed, %false otherwise
7072  */
7073 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7074 
7075 /**
7076  * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions
7077  *
7078  */
7079 
7080 /**
7081  * reg_query_regdb_wmm -  Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule
7082  * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively
7083  *
7084  * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried.
7085  * @freq: the frequency (in MHz) to be queried.
7086  * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db.
7087  *
7088  * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to  query
7089  * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given
7090  * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations.
7091  *
7092  * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
7093  * an -ENODATA.
7094  *
7095  * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA.
7096  */
7097 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq,
7098 			struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule);
7099 
7100 /*
7101  * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification
7102  * functions and BSS handling helpers
7103  */
7104 
7105 /**
7106  * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished
7107  *
7108  * @request: the corresponding scan request
7109  * @info: information about the completed scan
7110  */
7111 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request,
7112 			struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
7113 
7114 /**
7115  * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available
7116  *
7117  * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results
7118  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7119  */
7120 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7121 
7122 /**
7123  * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
7124  *
7125  * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
7126  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7127  *
7128  * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
7129  * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
7130  * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
7131  */
7132 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7133 
7134 /**
7135  * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
7136  *
7137  * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
7138  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7139  *
7140  * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
7141  * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
7142  * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
7143  * This function should be called with the wiphy mutex held.
7144  */
7145 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7146 
7147 /**
7148  * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame
7149  * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
7150  * @data: the BSS metadata
7151  * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon)
7152  * @len: length of the management frame
7153  * @gfp: context flags
7154  *
7155  * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
7156  * the BSS should be updated/added.
7157  *
7158  * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
7159  * Or %NULL on error.
7160  */
7161 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7162 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7163 			       struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
7164 			       struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
7165 			       gfp_t gfp);
7166 
7167 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7168 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7169 			  struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
7170 			  struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
7171 			  s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
7172 {
7173 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
7174 		.chan = rx_channel,
7175 		.signal = signal,
7176 	};
7177 
7178 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
7179 }
7180 
7181 /**
7182  * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID
7183  * @bssid: transmitter BSSID
7184  * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element
7185  * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element
7186  * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID
7187  */
7188 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid,
7189 					  u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid)
7190 {
7191 	u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid);
7192 	u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0);
7193 	u64 new_bssid_u64;
7194 
7195 	new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask;
7196 
7197 	new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask;
7198 
7199 	u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid);
7200 }
7201 
7202 /**
7203  * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited
7204  * @element: element to check
7205  * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element
7206  *
7207  * Return: %true if should be inherited, %false otherwise
7208  */
7209 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element,
7210 				   const struct element *non_inherit_element);
7211 
7212 /**
7213  * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs
7214  * @ie: ies
7215  * @ielen: length of IEs
7216  * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element
7217  * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile)
7218  * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile
7219  * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length
7220  *
7221  * Return: the number of bytes merged
7222  */
7223 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7224 			      const struct element *mbssid_elem,
7225 			      const struct element *sub_elem,
7226 			      u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len);
7227 
7228 /**
7229  * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from
7230  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is
7231  *	from a beacon or probe response
7232  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon
7233  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response
7234  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_S1G_BEACON: data comes from an S1G beacon
7235  */
7236 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type {
7237 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN,
7238 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON,
7239 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP,
7240 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_S1G_BEACON,
7241 };
7242 
7243 /**
7244  * cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number - returns the channel number from ies
7245  * @ie: IEs
7246  * @ielen: length of IEs
7247  * @band: enum nl80211_band of the channel
7248  *
7249  * Return: the channel number, or -1 if none could be determined.
7250  */
7251 int cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7252 				    enum nl80211_band band);
7253 
7254 /**
7255  * cfg80211_ssid_eq - compare two SSIDs
7256  * @a: first SSID
7257  * @b: second SSID
7258  *
7259  * Return: %true if SSIDs are equal, %false otherwise.
7260  */
7261 static inline bool
7262 cfg80211_ssid_eq(struct cfg80211_ssid *a, struct cfg80211_ssid *b)
7263 {
7264 	if (WARN_ON(!a || !b))
7265 		return false;
7266 	if (a->ssid_len != b->ssid_len)
7267 		return false;
7268 	return memcmp(a->ssid, b->ssid, a->ssid_len) ? false : true;
7269 }
7270 
7271 /**
7272  * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS
7273  *
7274  * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
7275  * @data: the BSS metadata
7276  * @ftype: frame type (if known)
7277  * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS
7278  * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0)
7279  * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer
7280  * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer
7281  * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer
7282  * @ielen: length of the additional IEs
7283  * @gfp: context flags
7284  *
7285  * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
7286  * the BSS should be updated/added.
7287  *
7288  * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
7289  * Or %NULL on error.
7290  */
7291 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7292 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7293 			 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
7294 			 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
7295 			 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
7296 			 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7297 			 gfp_t gfp);
7298 
7299 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7300 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7301 		    struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
7302 		    enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
7303 		    const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
7304 		    u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7305 		    s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
7306 {
7307 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
7308 		.chan = rx_channel,
7309 		.signal = signal,
7310 	};
7311 
7312 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
7313 					capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
7314 					gfp);
7315 }
7316 
7317 /**
7318  * __cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
7319  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7320  * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
7321  * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
7322  * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
7323  * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
7324  * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
7325  * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
7326  * @use_for: indicates which use is intended
7327  *
7328  * Return: Reference-counted BSS on success. %NULL on error.
7329  */
7330 struct cfg80211_bss *__cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7331 					struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7332 					const u8 *bssid,
7333 					const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
7334 					enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
7335 					enum ieee80211_privacy privacy,
7336 					u32 use_for);
7337 
7338 /**
7339  * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
7340  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7341  * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
7342  * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
7343  * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
7344  * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
7345  * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
7346  * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
7347  *
7348  * This version implies regular usage, %NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL.
7349  *
7350  * Return: Reference-counted BSS on success. %NULL on error.
7351  */
7352 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
7353 cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7354 		 const u8 *bssid, const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
7355 		 enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
7356 		 enum ieee80211_privacy privacy)
7357 {
7358 	return __cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, bssid, ssid, ssid_len,
7359 				  bss_type, privacy,
7360 				  NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL);
7361 }
7362 
7363 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
7364 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7365 		  struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7366 		  const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len)
7367 {
7368 	return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len,
7369 				IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
7370 				IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY);
7371 }
7372 
7373 /**
7374  * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct
7375  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7376  * @bss: the BSS struct to reference
7377  *
7378  * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct.
7379  */
7380 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7381 
7382 /**
7383  * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct
7384  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7385  * @bss: the BSS struct
7386  *
7387  * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct.
7388  */
7389 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7390 
7391 /**
7392  * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures
7393  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7394  * @bss: the bss to remove
7395  *
7396  * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures
7397  * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this
7398  * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time
7399  * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all.
7400  */
7401 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7402 
7403 /**
7404  * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries
7405  *
7406  * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy
7407  * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not
7408  * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB.
7409  *
7410  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7411  * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel
7412  *     of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel.
7413  * @iter: the iterator function to call
7414  * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function
7415  */
7416 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7417 		       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7418 		       void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7419 				    struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
7420 				    void *data),
7421 		       void *iter_data);
7422 
7423 /**
7424  * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame
7425  * @dev: network device
7426  * @buf: authentication frame (header + body)
7427  * @len: length of the frame data
7428  *
7429  * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or
7430  * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode.
7431  * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must
7432  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7433  * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
7434  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7435  * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed
7436  * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used
7437  * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function
7438  * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead.
7439  *
7440  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7441  */
7442 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
7443 
7444 /**
7445  * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication
7446  * @dev: network device
7447  * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out
7448  *
7449  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's
7450  * mutex.
7451  */
7452 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
7453 
7454 /**
7455  * struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data - association response data
7456  * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body)
7457  * @len: length of the frame data
7458  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format
7459  *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
7460  * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame
7461  * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data
7462  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address (in case of MLO)
7463  * @links: per-link information indexed by link ID, use links[0] for
7464  *	non-MLO connections
7465  * @links.bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the
7466  *      pointer moves to cfg80211 in the call to cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp()
7467  * @links.status: Set this (along with a BSS pointer) for links that
7468  *	were rejected by the AP.
7469  */
7470 struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data {
7471 	const u8 *buf;
7472 	size_t len;
7473 	const u8 *req_ies;
7474 	size_t req_ies_len;
7475 	int uapsd_queues;
7476 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7477 	struct {
7478 		u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
7479 		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7480 		u16 status;
7481 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7482 };
7483 
7484 /**
7485  * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response
7486  * @dev: network device
7487  * @data: association response data, &struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data
7488  *
7489  * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
7490  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7491  *
7492  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7493  */
7494 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev,
7495 			    const struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data *data);
7496 
7497 /**
7498  * struct cfg80211_assoc_failure - association failure data
7499  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address, or %NULL
7500  * @bss: list of BSSes, must use entry 0 for non-MLO connections
7501  *	(@ap_mld_addr is %NULL)
7502  * @timeout: indicates the association failed due to timeout, otherwise
7503  *	the association was abandoned for a reason reported through some
7504  *	other API (e.g. deauth RX)
7505  */
7506 struct cfg80211_assoc_failure {
7507 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7508 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7509 	bool timeout;
7510 };
7511 
7512 /**
7513  * cfg80211_assoc_failure - notification of association failure
7514  * @dev: network device
7515  * @data: data describing the association failure
7516  *
7517  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7518  */
7519 void cfg80211_assoc_failure(struct net_device *dev,
7520 			    struct cfg80211_assoc_failure *data);
7521 
7522 /**
7523  * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame
7524  * @dev: network device
7525  * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body)
7526  * @len: length of the frame data
7527  * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired (include the nl80211 attribute)
7528  *
7529  * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in
7530  * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and
7531  * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the
7532  * corresponding wdev's mutex.
7533  */
7534 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
7535 			   bool reconnect);
7536 
7537 /**
7538  * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame
7539  * @dev: network device
7540  * @buf: received management frame (header + body)
7541  * @len: length of the frame data
7542  *
7543  * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc
7544  * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the
7545  * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon
7546  * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while
7547  * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
7548  *
7549  * This function may sleep.
7550  */
7551 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev,
7552 				  const u8 *buf, size_t len);
7553 
7554 /**
7555  * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP)
7556  * @dev: network device
7557  * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame
7558  * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used
7559  * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing.
7560  * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets)
7561  * @gfp: allocation flags
7562  *
7563  * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a
7564  * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication()
7565  * primitive.
7566  */
7567 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
7568 				  enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id,
7569 				  const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp);
7570 
7571 /**
7572  * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS
7573  *
7574  * @dev: network device
7575  * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined
7576  * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined
7577  * @gfp: allocation flags
7578  *
7579  * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or
7580  * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called,
7581  * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of
7582  * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called
7583  * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is
7584  * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest.
7585  */
7586 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7587 			  struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp);
7588 
7589 /**
7590  * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer
7591  * 					candidate
7592  *
7593  * @dev: network device
7594  * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate
7595  * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate
7596  * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer
7597  * @sig_dbm: signal level in dBm
7598  * @gfp: allocation flags
7599  *
7600  * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been
7601  * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response.
7602  * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace.
7603  */
7604 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev,
7605 		const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len,
7606 		int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp);
7607 
7608 /**
7609  * DOC: RFkill integration
7610  *
7611  * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers,
7612  * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each
7613  * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated
7614  * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off. Drivers are
7615  * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down.
7616  *
7617  * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they
7618  * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211.
7619  * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here.
7620  */
7621 
7622 /**
7623  * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason - notify cfg80211 about hw block state
7624  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7625  * @blocked: block status
7626  * @reason: one of reasons in &enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons
7627  */
7628 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked,
7629 				      enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons reason);
7630 
7631 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked)
7632 {
7633 	wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(wiphy, blocked,
7634 					 RFKILL_HARD_BLOCK_SIGNAL);
7635 }
7636 
7637 /**
7638  * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill
7639  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7640  */
7641 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7642 
7643 /**
7644  * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill
7645  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7646  */
7647 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy)
7648 {
7649 	rfkill_pause_polling(wiphy->rfkill);
7650 }
7651 
7652 /**
7653  * DOC: Vendor commands
7654  *
7655  * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that
7656  * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the
7657  * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with
7658  * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as
7659  * the configuration mechanism.
7660  *
7661  * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array
7662  * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one. Each command has an
7663  * OUI and sub command ID to identify it.
7664  *
7665  * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol
7666  * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular,
7667  * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any
7668  * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection
7669  * managers etc. need.
7670  */
7671 
7672 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7673 					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
7674 					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
7675 					   int approxlen);
7676 
7677 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7678 					   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7679 					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
7680 					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
7681 					   unsigned int portid,
7682 					   int vendor_event_idx,
7683 					   int approxlen, gfp_t gfp);
7684 
7685 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp);
7686 
7687 /**
7688  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply
7689  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7690  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7691  *	be put into the skb
7692  *
7693  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
7694  * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
7695  * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid.
7696  *
7697  * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in
7698  * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
7699  * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
7700  * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
7701  * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
7702  * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute.
7703  * You must not modify the skb in any other way.
7704  *
7705  * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return
7706  * its error code as the result of the doit() operation.
7707  *
7708  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7709  */
7710 static inline struct sk_buff *
7711 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
7712 {
7713 	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7714 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen);
7715 }
7716 
7717 /**
7718  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb
7719  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7720  *	cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb()
7721  *
7722  * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
7723  * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should
7724  * return the error code.  Note that this function consumes the
7725  * skb regardless of the return value.
7726  *
7727  * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
7728  */
7729 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb);
7730 
7731 /**
7732  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender - get the current sender netlink ID
7733  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7734  *
7735  * Return: the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler.
7736  *
7737  * Context: May only be called from a vendor command handler
7738  */
7739 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7740 
7741 /**
7742  * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb
7743  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7744  * @wdev: the wireless device
7745  * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
7746  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7747  *	be put into the skb
7748  * @gfp: allocation flags
7749  *
7750  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
7751  * vendor-specific multicast group.
7752  *
7753  * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
7754  * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
7755  * attribute.
7756  *
7757  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
7758  * skb to send the event.
7759  *
7760  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7761  */
7762 static inline struct sk_buff *
7763 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7764 			     int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
7765 {
7766 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7767 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
7768 					  0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
7769 }
7770 
7771 /**
7772  * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb
7773  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7774  * @wdev: the wireless device
7775  * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
7776  * @portid: port ID of the receiver
7777  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7778  *	be put into the skb
7779  * @gfp: allocation flags
7780  *
7781  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to
7782  * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been
7783  * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take
7784  * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes.
7785  *
7786  * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
7787  * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
7788  * attribute.
7789  *
7790  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
7791  * skb to send the event.
7792  *
7793  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7794  */
7795 static inline struct sk_buff *
7796 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7797 				  struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7798 				  unsigned int portid, int approxlen,
7799 				  int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
7800 {
7801 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7802 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
7803 					  portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
7804 }
7805 
7806 /**
7807  * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event
7808  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc()
7809  * @gfp: allocation flags
7810  *
7811  * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
7812  * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it.
7813  */
7814 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
7815 {
7816 	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
7817 }
7818 
7819 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
7820 /**
7821  * DOC: Test mode
7822  *
7823  * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to
7824  * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance,
7825  * factory programming.
7826  *
7827  * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it. For more
7828  * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it.
7829  */
7830 
7831 /**
7832  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply
7833  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7834  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7835  *	be put into the skb
7836  *
7837  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
7838  * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
7839  * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid.
7840  *
7841  * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in
7842  * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
7843  * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
7844  * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
7845  * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
7846  * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You
7847  * must not modify the skb in any other way.
7848  *
7849  * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return
7850  * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation.
7851  *
7852  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7853  */
7854 static inline struct sk_buff *
7855 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
7856 {
7857 	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
7858 					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen);
7859 }
7860 
7861 /**
7862  * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb
7863  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7864  *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb()
7865  *
7866  * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
7867  * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return
7868  * the error code.  Note that this function consumes the skb
7869  * regardless of the return value.
7870  *
7871  * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
7872  */
7873 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb)
7874 {
7875 	return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb);
7876 }
7877 
7878 /**
7879  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event
7880  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7881  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7882  *	be put into the skb
7883  * @gfp: allocation flags
7884  *
7885  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
7886  * testmode multicast group.
7887  *
7888  * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with
7889  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As
7890  * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the
7891  * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb
7892  * in any other way.
7893  *
7894  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the
7895  * skb to send the event.
7896  *
7897  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7898  */
7899 static inline struct sk_buff *
7900 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp)
7901 {
7902 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
7903 					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1,
7904 					  approxlen, gfp);
7905 }
7906 
7907 /**
7908  * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event
7909  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7910  *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb()
7911  * @gfp: allocation flags
7912  *
7913  * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
7914  * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always
7915  * consumes it.
7916  */
7917 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
7918 {
7919 	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
7920 }
7921 
7922 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)	.testmode_cmd = (cmd),
7923 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)	.testmode_dump = (cmd),
7924 #else
7925 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)
7926 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)
7927 #endif
7928 
7929 /**
7930  * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params
7931  * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL)
7932  * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets
7933  * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in
7934  *	@erp_next_seq_num is valid.
7935  * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in
7936  *	FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the
7937  *	status for a FILS connection.
7938  * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL).
7939  * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets
7940  * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID
7941  *	used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL).
7942  */
7943 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params {
7944 	const u8 *kek;
7945 	size_t kek_len;
7946 	bool update_erp_next_seq_num;
7947 	u16 erp_next_seq_num;
7948 	const u8 *pmk;
7949 	size_t pmk_len;
7950 	const u8 *pmkid;
7951 };
7952 
7953 /**
7954  * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params
7955  * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
7956  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
7957  *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
7958  *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
7959  *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
7960  *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
7961  *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
7962  *	case.
7963  * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL)
7964  * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length
7965  * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7966  * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length
7967  * @fils: FILS connection response parameters.
7968  * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
7969  *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
7970  *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
7971  *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
7972  *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
7973  *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
7974  * @valid_links: For MLO connection, BIT mask of the valid link ids. Otherwise
7975  *	zero.
7976  * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the AP. Otherwise %NULL.
7977  * @links : For MLO connection, contains link info for the valid links indicated
7978  *	using @valid_links. For non-MLO connection, links[0] contains the
7979  *	connected AP info.
7980  * @links.addr: For MLO connection, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise
7981  *	%NULL.
7982  * @links.bssid: For MLO connection, MAC address of the AP link. For non-MLO
7983  *	connection, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL).
7984  * @links.bss: For MLO connection, entry of bss to which STA link is connected.
7985  *	For non-MLO connection, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to which STA
7986  *	is connected. It can be obtained through cfg80211_get_bss() (may be
7987  *	%NULL). It is recommended to store the bss from the connect_request and
7988  *	hold a reference to it and return through this param to avoid a warning
7989  *	if the bss is expired during the connection, esp. for those drivers
7990  *	implementing connect op. Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs
7991  *	to be specified.
7992  * @links.status: per-link status code, to report a status code that's not
7993  *	%WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for a given link, it must also be in the
7994  *	@valid_links bitmap and may have a BSS pointer (which is then released)
7995  */
7996 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params {
7997 	int status;
7998 	const u8 *req_ie;
7999 	size_t req_ie_len;
8000 	const u8 *resp_ie;
8001 	size_t resp_ie_len;
8002 	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
8003 	enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason;
8004 
8005 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
8006 	u16 valid_links;
8007 	struct {
8008 		const u8 *addr;
8009 		const u8 *bssid;
8010 		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
8011 		u16 status;
8012 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
8013 };
8014 
8015 /**
8016  * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result
8017  *
8018  * @dev: network device
8019  * @params: connection response parameters
8020  * @gfp: allocation flags
8021  *
8022  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
8023  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
8024  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response
8025  * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(),
8026  * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(),
8027  * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8028  */
8029 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev,
8030 			   struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params,
8031 			   gfp_t gfp);
8032 
8033 /**
8034  * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result
8035  *
8036  * @dev: network device
8037  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
8038  * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
8039  *	cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
8040  *	bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
8041  *	through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
8042  *	connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
8043  *	Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
8044  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8045  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8046  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8047  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
8048  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
8049  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
8050  *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
8051  *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
8052  *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
8053  *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
8054  *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
8055  *	case.
8056  * @gfp: allocation flags
8057  * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
8058  *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
8059  *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
8060  *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
8061  *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
8062  *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
8063  *
8064  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
8065  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
8066  * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss
8067  * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among
8068  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8069  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8070  */
8071 static inline void
8072 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8073 		     struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie,
8074 		     size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie,
8075 		     size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp,
8076 		     enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
8077 {
8078 	struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params;
8079 
8080 	memset(&params, 0, sizeof(params));
8081 	params.status = status;
8082 	params.links[0].bssid = bssid;
8083 	params.links[0].bss = bss;
8084 	params.req_ie = req_ie;
8085 	params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len;
8086 	params.resp_ie = resp_ie;
8087 	params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len;
8088 	params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason;
8089 
8090 	cfg80211_connect_done(dev, &params, gfp);
8091 }
8092 
8093 /**
8094  * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result
8095  *
8096  * @dev: network device
8097  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
8098  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8099  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8100  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8101  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
8102  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
8103  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
8104  *	the real status code for failures.
8105  * @gfp: allocation flags
8106  *
8107  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
8108  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
8109  * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only
8110  * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8111  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8112  */
8113 static inline void
8114 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8115 			const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len,
8116 			const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len,
8117 			u16 status, gfp_t gfp)
8118 {
8119 	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie,
8120 			     resp_ie_len, status, gfp,
8121 			     NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED);
8122 }
8123 
8124 /**
8125  * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout
8126  *
8127  * @dev: network device
8128  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
8129  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8130  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8131  * @gfp: allocation flags
8132  * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout.
8133  *
8134  * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed
8135  * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was
8136  * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send
8137  * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while
8138  * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among
8139  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8140  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8141  */
8142 static inline void
8143 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8144 			 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp,
8145 			 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
8146 {
8147 	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1,
8148 			     gfp, timeout_reason);
8149 }
8150 
8151 /**
8152  * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information
8153  *
8154  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8155  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8156  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8157  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
8158  * @fils: FILS related roaming information.
8159  * @valid_links: For MLO roaming, BIT mask of the new valid links is set.
8160  *	Otherwise zero.
8161  * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO roaming, MLD address of the new AP. Otherwise %NULL.
8162  * @links : For MLO roaming, contains new link info for the valid links set in
8163  *	@valid_links. For non-MLO roaming, links[0] contains the new AP info.
8164  * @links.addr: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise %NULL.
8165  * @links.bssid: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the new AP link. For non-MLO
8166  *	roaming, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the new AP. May be
8167  *	%NULL if %links.bss is set.
8168  * @links.channel: the channel of the new AP.
8169  * @links.bss: For MLO roaming, entry of new bss to which STA link got
8170  *	roamed. For non-MLO roaming, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to
8171  *	which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %links.bssid is set)
8172  */
8173 struct cfg80211_roam_info {
8174 	const u8 *req_ie;
8175 	size_t req_ie_len;
8176 	const u8 *resp_ie;
8177 	size_t resp_ie_len;
8178 	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
8179 
8180 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
8181 	u16 valid_links;
8182 	struct {
8183 		const u8 *addr;
8184 		const u8 *bssid;
8185 		struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
8186 		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
8187 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
8188 };
8189 
8190 /**
8191  * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming
8192  *
8193  * @dev: network device
8194  * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info.
8195  * @gfp: allocation flags
8196  *
8197  * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the
8198  * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry.
8199  * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP
8200  * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in
8201  * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where
8202  * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the
8203  * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling
8204  * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released
8205  * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be
8206  * released while disconnecting from the current bss.
8207  */
8208 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info,
8209 		     gfp_t gfp);
8210 
8211 /**
8212  * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association
8213  *
8214  * @dev: network device
8215  * @peer_addr: BSSID of the AP/P2P GO in case of STA/GC or STA/GC MAC address
8216  *	in case of AP/P2P GO
8217  * @td_bitmap: transition disable policy
8218  * @td_bitmap_len: Length of transition disable policy
8219  * @gfp: allocation flags
8220  *
8221  * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake
8222  * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e.,
8223  * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function
8224  * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(),
8225  * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to
8226  * indicate the 802.11 association.
8227  * This function can also be called by AP/P2P GO driver that supports
8228  * authentication offload. In this case the peer_mac passed is that of
8229  * associated STA/GC.
8230  */
8231 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer_addr,
8232 			      const u8* td_bitmap, u8 td_bitmap_len, gfp_t gfp);
8233 
8234 /**
8235  * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped
8236  *
8237  * @dev: network device
8238  * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL)
8239  * @ie_len: length of IEs
8240  * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown
8241  * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally
8242  * @gfp: allocation flags
8243  *
8244  * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state
8245  * and not try to connect to any AP any more.
8246  */
8247 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason,
8248 			   const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len,
8249 			   bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp);
8250 
8251 /**
8252  * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start
8253  * @wdev: wireless device
8254  * @cookie: the request cookie
8255  * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
8256  * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the
8257  *	channel
8258  * @gfp: allocation flags
8259  */
8260 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8261 			       struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
8262 			       unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp);
8263 
8264 /**
8265  * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
8266  * @wdev: wireless device
8267  * @cookie: the request cookie
8268  * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
8269  * @gfp: allocation flags
8270  */
8271 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8272 					struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
8273 					gfp_t gfp);
8274 
8275 /**
8276  * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired
8277  * @wdev: wireless device
8278  * @cookie: the requested cookie
8279  * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request)
8280  * @gfp: allocation flags
8281  */
8282 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8283 			      struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp);
8284 
8285 /**
8286  * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics.
8287  *
8288  * @sinfo: the station information
8289  * @gfp: allocation flags
8290  *
8291  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
8292  */
8293 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8294 
8295 /**
8296  * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info
8297  * @sinfo: the station information
8298  *
8299  * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station
8300  * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on
8301  * the stack.)
8302  */
8303 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo)
8304 {
8305 	kfree(sinfo->pertid);
8306 }
8307 
8308 /**
8309  * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station
8310  *
8311  * @dev: the netdev
8312  * @mac_addr: the station's address
8313  * @sinfo: the station information
8314  * @gfp: allocation flags
8315  */
8316 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8317 		      struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8318 
8319 /**
8320  * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station
8321  * @dev: the netdev
8322  * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used.
8323  * @sinfo: the station information/statistics
8324  * @gfp: allocation flags
8325  */
8326 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8327 			    struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8328 
8329 /**
8330  * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station
8331  *
8332  * @dev: the netdev
8333  * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used.
8334  * @gfp: allocation flags
8335  */
8336 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev,
8337 				    const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp)
8338 {
8339 	cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp);
8340 }
8341 
8342 /**
8343  * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification
8344  *
8345  * @dev: the netdev
8346  * @mac_addr: the station's address
8347  * @reason: the reason for connection failure
8348  * @gfp: allocation flags
8349  *
8350  * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station
8351  * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection
8352  * for some reasons, this function is called.
8353  *
8354  * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from
8355  * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum
8356  */
8357 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8358 			  enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason,
8359 			  gfp_t gfp);
8360 
8361 /**
8362  * struct cfg80211_rx_info - received management frame info
8363  *
8364  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in kHz
8365  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8366  * @have_link_id: indicates the frame was received on a link of
8367  *	an MLD, i.e. the @link_id field is valid
8368  * @link_id: the ID of the link the frame was received	on
8369  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8370  * @len: length of the frame data
8371  * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8372  * @rx_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of frame RX in nanoseconds
8373  * @ack_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of ack TX in nanoseconds
8374  */
8375 struct cfg80211_rx_info {
8376 	int freq;
8377 	int sig_dbm;
8378 	bool have_link_id;
8379 	u8 link_id;
8380 	const u8 *buf;
8381 	size_t len;
8382 	u32 flags;
8383 	u64 rx_tstamp;
8384 	u64 ack_tstamp;
8385 };
8386 
8387 /**
8388  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext - management frame notification with extended info
8389  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8390  * @info: RX info as defined in struct cfg80211_rx_info
8391  *
8392  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8393  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8394  *
8395  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8396  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8397  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8398  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8399  */
8400 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8401 			  struct cfg80211_rx_info *info);
8402 
8403 /**
8404  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
8405  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8406  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz
8407  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8408  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8409  * @len: length of the frame data
8410  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8411  *
8412  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8413  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8414  *
8415  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8416  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8417  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8418  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8419  */
8420 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
8421 					int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
8422 					u32 flags)
8423 {
8424 	struct cfg80211_rx_info info = {
8425 		.freq = freq,
8426 		.sig_dbm = sig_dbm,
8427 		.buf = buf,
8428 		.len = len,
8429 		.flags = flags
8430 	};
8431 
8432 	return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info);
8433 }
8434 
8435 /**
8436  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
8437  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8438  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz
8439  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8440  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8441  * @len: length of the frame data
8442  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8443  *
8444  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8445  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8446  *
8447  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8448  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8449  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8450  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8451  */
8452 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
8453 				    int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
8454 				    u32 flags)
8455 {
8456 	struct cfg80211_rx_info info = {
8457 		.freq = MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
8458 		.sig_dbm = sig_dbm,
8459 		.buf = buf,
8460 		.len = len,
8461 		.flags = flags
8462 	};
8463 
8464 	return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info);
8465 }
8466 
8467 /**
8468  * struct cfg80211_tx_status - TX status for management frame information
8469  *
8470  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
8471  * @tx_tstamp: hardware TX timestamp in nanoseconds
8472  * @ack_tstamp: hardware ack RX timestamp in nanoseconds
8473  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8474  * @len: length of the frame data
8475  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8476  */
8477 struct cfg80211_tx_status {
8478 	u64 cookie;
8479 	u64 tx_tstamp;
8480 	u64 ack_tstamp;
8481 	const u8 *buf;
8482 	size_t len;
8483 	bool ack;
8484 };
8485 
8486 /**
8487  * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext - TX status notification with extended info
8488  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8489  * @status: TX status data
8490  * @gfp: context flags
8491  *
8492  * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
8493  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
8494  * transmission attempt with extended info.
8495  */
8496 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8497 				 struct cfg80211_tx_status *status, gfp_t gfp);
8498 
8499 /**
8500  * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame
8501  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8502  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
8503  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8504  * @len: length of the frame data
8505  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8506  * @gfp: context flags
8507  *
8508  * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
8509  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
8510  * transmission attempt.
8511  */
8512 static inline void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8513 					   u64 cookie, const u8 *buf,
8514 					   size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp)
8515 {
8516 	struct cfg80211_tx_status status = {
8517 		.cookie = cookie,
8518 		.buf = buf,
8519 		.len = len,
8520 		.ack = ack
8521 	};
8522 
8523 	cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(wdev, &status, gfp);
8524 }
8525 
8526 /**
8527  * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control
8528  *                                   port frames
8529  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8530  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port()
8531  * @buf: Data frame (header + body)
8532  * @len: length of the frame data
8533  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8534  * @gfp: context flags
8535  *
8536  * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be
8537  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of
8538  * the transmission attempt.
8539  */
8540 void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8541 				     const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack,
8542 				     gfp_t gfp);
8543 
8544 /**
8545  * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame
8546  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8547  * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame.  It is assumed that the skbuf
8548  *	is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header).  The skb can be non-linear.
8549  *	This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is
8550  *	responsible for any cleanup.  The caller must also ensure that
8551  *	skb->protocol is set appropriately.
8552  * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted
8553  * @link_id: the link the frame was received on, -1 if not applicable or unknown
8554  *
8555  * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port
8556  * frame.  It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive
8557  * control port frames over nl80211.
8558  *
8559  * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all
8560  * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame).
8561  *
8562  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace
8563  */
8564 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev, struct sk_buff *skb,
8565 			      bool unencrypted, int link_id);
8566 
8567 /**
8568  * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event
8569  * @dev: network device
8570  * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event
8571  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
8572  * @gfp: context flags
8573  *
8574  * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring
8575  * rssi threshold reached event occurs.
8576  */
8577 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8578 			      enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
8579 			      s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp);
8580 
8581 /**
8582  * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer
8583  * @dev: network device
8584  * @peer: peer's MAC address
8585  * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold
8586  *	but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent
8587  *	threshold (to account for temporary interference)
8588  * @gfp: context flags
8589  */
8590 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8591 				 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp);
8592 
8593 /**
8594  * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event
8595  * @dev: network device
8596  * @peer: peer's MAC address
8597  * @num_packets: how many packets were lost
8598  * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission
8599  * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached.
8600  * @gfp: context flags
8601  *
8602  * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a
8603  * given interval is exceeded.
8604  */
8605 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
8606 			     u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp);
8607 
8608 /**
8609  * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event
8610  * @dev: network device
8611  * @gfp: context flags
8612  *
8613  * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP.
8614  */
8615 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp);
8616 
8617 /**
8618  * __cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event
8619  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8620  * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
8621  * @offchan: the radar has been detected on the offchannel chain
8622  * @gfp: context flags
8623  *
8624  * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl.
8625  */
8626 void __cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8627 			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8628 			    bool offchan, gfp_t gfp);
8629 
8630 static inline void
8631 cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8632 		     struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8633 		     gfp_t gfp)
8634 {
8635 	__cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, false, gfp);
8636 }
8637 
8638 static inline void
8639 cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8640 				struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8641 				gfp_t gfp)
8642 {
8643 	__cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, true, gfp);
8644 }
8645 
8646 /**
8647  * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event
8648  * @dev: network device
8649  * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified
8650  * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value
8651  * @gfp: context flags
8652  *
8653  * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action
8654  * frame.
8655  */
8656 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac,
8657 				       struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode,
8658 				       gfp_t gfp);
8659 
8660 /**
8661  * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event
8662  * @netdev: network device
8663  * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
8664  * @event: type of event
8665  * @gfp: context flags
8666  *
8667  * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished
8668  * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process,
8669  * also by full-MAC drivers.
8670  */
8671 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev,
8672 			const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8673 			enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp);
8674 
8675 /**
8676  * cfg80211_background_cac_abort - Channel Availability Check offchan abort event
8677  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8678  *
8679  * This function is called by the driver when a Channel Availability Check
8680  * (CAC) is aborted by a offchannel dedicated chain.
8681  */
8682 void cfg80211_background_cac_abort(struct wiphy *wiphy);
8683 
8684 /**
8685  * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying
8686  * @dev: network device
8687  * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races)
8688  * @replay_ctr: new replay counter
8689  * @gfp: allocation flags
8690  */
8691 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8692 			       const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
8693 
8694 /**
8695  * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate
8696  * @dev: network device
8697  * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority)
8698  * @bssid: BSSID of AP
8699  * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication
8700  * @gfp: allocation flags
8701  */
8702 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index,
8703 				     const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp);
8704 
8705 /**
8706  * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame
8707  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8708  * @addr: the transmitter address
8709  * @gfp: context flags
8710  *
8711  * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
8712  * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the
8713  * sender.
8714  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
8715  * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
8716  */
8717 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev,
8718 				const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
8719 
8720 /**
8721  * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame
8722  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8723  * @addr: the transmitter address
8724  * @gfp: context flags
8725  *
8726  * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
8727  * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected.
8728  * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each
8729  * station to avoid event flooding.
8730  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
8731  * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
8732  */
8733 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev,
8734 					const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
8735 
8736 /**
8737  * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status
8738  * @dev: the device the probe was sent on
8739  * @addr: the address of the peer
8740  * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously
8741  * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not
8742  * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame.
8743  * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not.
8744  * @gfp: allocation flags
8745  */
8746 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
8747 			   u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal,
8748 			   bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp);
8749 
8750 /**
8751  * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs
8752  * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
8753  * @frame: the frame
8754  * @len: length of the frame
8755  * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz
8756  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8757  *
8758  * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
8759  * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
8760  * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
8761  */
8762 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame,
8763 				     size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm);
8764 
8765 /**
8766  * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs
8767  * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
8768  * @frame: the frame
8769  * @len: length of the frame
8770  * @freq: frequency the frame was received on
8771  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8772  *
8773  * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
8774  * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
8775  * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
8776  */
8777 static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8778 					       const u8 *frame, size_t len,
8779 					       int freq, int sig_dbm)
8780 {
8781 	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
8782 					sig_dbm);
8783 }
8784 
8785 /**
8786  * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed
8787  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8788  * @chandef: the channel definition
8789  * @iftype: interface type
8790  *
8791  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
8792  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.)
8793  */
8794 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8795 			     struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8796 			     enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
8797 
8798 /**
8799  * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation
8800  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8801  * @chandef: the channel definition
8802  * @iftype: interface type
8803  *
8804  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
8805  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version
8806  * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under
8807  * more permissive conditions.
8808  *
8809  * Context: Requires the wiphy mutex to be held.
8810  */
8811 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8812 				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8813 				   enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
8814 
8815 /**
8816  * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace
8817  * @dev: the device which switched channels
8818  * @chandef: the new channel definition
8819  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO
8820  *
8821  * Caller must hold wiphy mutex, therefore must only be called from sleepable
8822  * driver context!
8823  */
8824 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8825 			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8826 			       unsigned int link_id);
8827 
8828 /**
8829  * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start
8830  * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started
8831  * @chandef: the future channel definition
8832  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO
8833  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens
8834  * @quiet: whether or not immediate quiet was requested by the AP
8835  *
8836  * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just
8837  * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting
8838  * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary.
8839  */
8840 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8841 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8842 				       unsigned int link_id, u8 count,
8843 				       bool quiet);
8844 
8845 /**
8846  * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band
8847  *
8848  * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
8849  * @band: band pointer to fill
8850  *
8851  * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
8852  */
8853 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class,
8854 				       enum nl80211_band *band);
8855 
8856 /**
8857  * ieee80211_operating_class_to_chandef - convert operating class to chandef
8858  *
8859  * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
8860  * @chan: the ieee80211_channel to convert
8861  * @chandef: a pointer to the resulting chandef
8862  *
8863  * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
8864  */
8865 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_chandef(u8 operating_class,
8866 					  struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
8867 					  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
8868 
8869 /**
8870  * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class
8871  *
8872  * @chandef: the chandef to convert
8873  * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class
8874  *
8875  * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
8876  */
8877 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8878 					  u8 *op_class);
8879 
8880 /**
8881  * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz
8882  *
8883  * @chandef: the chandef to convert
8884  *
8885  * Return: the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz.
8886  */
8887 static inline u32
8888 ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
8889 {
8890 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset;
8891 }
8892 
8893 /**
8894  * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation
8895  * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested
8896  * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device
8897  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or
8898  *	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN)
8899  * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request
8900  * @gfp: allocation flags
8901  *
8902  * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that
8903  * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP
8904  * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use
8905  * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g.,
8906  * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer).
8907  */
8908 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
8909 				enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
8910 				u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
8911 
8912 /**
8913  * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units)
8914  * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from
8915  *
8916  * Return: calculated bitrate
8917  */
8918 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate);
8919 
8920 /**
8921  * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev
8922  * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove
8923  *
8924  * This function removes the device so it can no longer be used. It is necessary
8925  * to call this function even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the device
8926  * by calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also be called
8927  * when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. when the hardware device
8928  * is unbound from the driver.
8929  *
8930  * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
8931  */
8932 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
8933 
8934 /**
8935  * cfg80211_register_netdevice - register the given netdev
8936  * @dev: the netdev to register
8937  *
8938  * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
8939  * than register_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL is
8940  * held. Otherwise, both register_netdevice() and register_netdev() are usable
8941  * instead as well.
8942  *
8943  * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
8944  *
8945  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
8946  */
8947 int cfg80211_register_netdevice(struct net_device *dev);
8948 
8949 /**
8950  * cfg80211_unregister_netdevice - unregister the given netdev
8951  * @dev: the netdev to register
8952  *
8953  * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
8954  * than unregister_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL
8955  * is held. Otherwise, both unregister_netdevice() and unregister_netdev() are
8956  * usable instead as well.
8957  *
8958  * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
8959  */
8960 static inline void cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device *dev)
8961 {
8962 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
8963 	cfg80211_unregister_wdev(dev->ieee80211_ptr);
8964 #endif
8965 }
8966 
8967 /**
8968  * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements
8969  * @ies: FT IEs
8970  * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes
8971  * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address
8972  * @ric_ies: RIC IE
8973  * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes
8974  */
8975 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params {
8976 	const u8 *ies;
8977 	size_t ies_len;
8978 	const u8 *target_ap;
8979 	const u8 *ric_ies;
8980 	size_t ric_ies_len;
8981 };
8982 
8983 /**
8984  * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE
8985  * @netdev: network device
8986  * @ft_event: IE information
8987  */
8988 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev,
8989 		       struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event);
8990 
8991 /**
8992  * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer
8993  * @ies: the input IE buffer
8994  * @len: the input length
8995  * @attr: the attribute ID to find
8996  * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g.
8997  *	if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size
8998  * @bufsize: size of the output buffer
8999  *
9000  * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and
9001  * copies its contents to the given buffer.
9002  *
9003  * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is
9004  * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the
9005  * length of the found attribute (which can be zero).
9006  */
9007 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
9008 			  enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr,
9009 			  u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize);
9010 
9011 /**
9012  * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC)
9013  * @ies: the IE buffer
9014  * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
9015  * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
9016  *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
9017  *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
9018  * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
9019  * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element
9020  * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array
9021  * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
9022  *
9023  * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
9024  * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
9025  * split.
9026  *
9027  * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
9028  * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
9029  *
9030  * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
9031  * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
9032  * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
9033  *
9034  * Return: The offset where the next part of the buffer starts, which
9035  * may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) of the buffer should be
9036  * used.
9037  */
9038 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
9039 			      const u8 *ids, int n_ids,
9040 			      const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric,
9041 			      size_t offset);
9042 
9043 /**
9044  * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering
9045  * @ies: the IE buffer
9046  * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
9047  * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
9048  *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
9049  *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
9050  * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
9051  * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
9052  *
9053  * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
9054  * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
9055  * split.
9056  *
9057  * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
9058  * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
9059  *
9060  * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
9061  * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
9062  * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
9063  *
9064  * Return: The offset where the next part of the buffer starts, which
9065  * may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) of the buffer should be
9066  * used.
9067  */
9068 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
9069 					const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset)
9070 {
9071 	return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset);
9072 }
9073 
9074 /**
9075  * ieee80211_fragment_element - fragment the last element in skb
9076  * @skb: The skbuf that the element was added to
9077  * @len_pos: Pointer to length of the element to fragment
9078  * @frag_id: The element ID to use for fragments
9079  *
9080  * This function fragments all data after @len_pos, adding fragmentation
9081  * elements with the given ID as appropriate. The SKB will grow in size
9082  * accordingly.
9083  */
9084 void ieee80211_fragment_element(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *len_pos, u8 frag_id);
9085 
9086 /**
9087  * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN
9088  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup
9089  * @wakeup: the wakeup report
9090  * @gfp: allocation flags
9091  *
9092  * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it
9093  * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may
9094  * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something
9095  * else caused the wakeup.
9096  */
9097 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9098 				   struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
9099 				   gfp_t gfp);
9100 
9101 /**
9102  * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver.
9103  *
9104  * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped.
9105  * @gfp: allocation flags
9106  *
9107  * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted
9108  * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given
9109  * by .crit_proto_start() has expired.
9110  */
9111 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp);
9112 
9113 /**
9114  * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has
9115  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9116  *
9117  * Return: the number of channels supported by the device.
9118  */
9119 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9120 
9121 /**
9122  * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations
9123  *
9124  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9125  * @params: the interface combinations parameter
9126  *
9127  * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a
9128  * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to
9129  * the interface combinations.
9130  *
9131  * Return: 0 if combinations are allowed. Non-zero on error.
9132  */
9133 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9134 				struct iface_combination_params *params);
9135 
9136 /**
9137  * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations
9138  *
9139  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9140  * @params: the interface combinations parameter
9141  * @iter: function to call for each matching combination
9142  * @data: pointer to pass to iter function
9143  *
9144  * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible
9145  * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching
9146  * purposes.
9147  *
9148  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9149  */
9150 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9151 			       struct iface_combination_params *params,
9152 			       void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c,
9153 					    void *data),
9154 			       void *data);
9155 
9156 /**
9157  * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection
9158  *
9159  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9160  * @wdev: wireless device
9161  * @gfp: context flags
9162  *
9163  * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA
9164  * disconnected.
9165  *
9166  * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous.
9167  */
9168 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9169 			 gfp_t gfp);
9170 
9171 /**
9172  * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy
9173  * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down
9174  *
9175  * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by
9176  * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed).
9177  * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors
9178  * that really can't be recovered in any other way.
9179  *
9180  * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into
9181  * the driver while the function is running.
9182  */
9183 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9184 
9185 /**
9186  * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag
9187  *
9188  * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
9189  * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
9190  *
9191  * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
9192  * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
9193  */
9194 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9195 					 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
9196 {
9197 	u8 *ft_byte;
9198 
9199 	ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
9200 	*ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8);
9201 }
9202 
9203 /**
9204  * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag
9205  *
9206  * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
9207  * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
9208  *
9209  * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
9210  * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
9211  *
9212  * Return: %true if extended feature flag is set, %false otherwise
9213  */
9214 static inline bool
9215 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9216 			enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
9217 {
9218 	u8 ft_byte;
9219 
9220 	ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
9221 	return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0;
9222 }
9223 
9224 /**
9225  * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function
9226  * @f: NAN function that should be freed
9227  *
9228  * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members.
9229  */
9230 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f);
9231 
9232 /**
9233  * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters
9234  * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is
9235  *	 %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber.
9236  *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery
9237  *	 result.
9238  *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up.
9239  * @inst_id: the local instance id
9240  * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function
9241  * @addr: the MAC address of the peer
9242  * @info_len: the length of the &info
9243  * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any)
9244  * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function
9245  */
9246 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params {
9247 	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
9248 	u8 inst_id;
9249 	u8 peer_inst_id;
9250 	const u8 *addr;
9251 	u8 info_len;
9252 	const u8 *info;
9253 	u64 cookie;
9254 };
9255 
9256 /**
9257  * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function.
9258  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
9259  * @match: match notification parameters
9260  * @gfp: allocation flags
9261  *
9262  * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This
9263  * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that
9264  * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received.
9265  */
9266 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9267 			struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp);
9268 
9269 /**
9270  * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
9271  *
9272  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
9273  * @inst_id: the local instance id
9274  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
9275  * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier
9276  * @gfp: allocation flags
9277  *
9278  * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated.
9279  */
9280 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9281 				  u8 inst_id,
9282 				  enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
9283 				  u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp);
9284 
9285 /* ethtool helper */
9286 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info);
9287 
9288 /**
9289  * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication
9290  * @netdev: network device
9291  * @params: External authentication parameters
9292  * @gfp: allocation flags
9293  * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error
9294  */
9295 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev,
9296 				   struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params,
9297 				   gfp_t gfp);
9298 
9299 /**
9300  * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data
9301  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
9302  * @req: the original measurement request
9303  * @result: the result data
9304  * @gfp: allocation flags
9305  */
9306 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9307 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
9308 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result,
9309 			  gfp_t gfp);
9310 
9311 /**
9312  * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed
9313  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
9314  * @req: the original measurement request
9315  * @gfp: allocation flags
9316  *
9317  * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this
9318  * the request pointer will no longer be valid.
9319  */
9320 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9321 			    struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
9322 			    gfp_t gfp);
9323 
9324 /**
9325  * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed
9326  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9327  * @iftype: interface type
9328  * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1'
9329  * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces
9330  *
9331  * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API
9332  * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when
9333  * check_swif is '1'.
9334  *
9335  * Return: %true if allowed, %false otherwise
9336  */
9337 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
9338 			     bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif);
9339 
9340 
9341 /**
9342  * cfg80211_assoc_comeback - notification of association that was
9343  * temporarily rejected with a comeback
9344  * @netdev: network device
9345  * @ap_addr: AP (MLD) address that rejected the association
9346  * @timeout: timeout interval value TUs.
9347  *
9348  * this function may sleep. the caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
9349  */
9350 void cfg80211_assoc_comeback(struct net_device *netdev,
9351 			     const u8 *ap_addr, u32 timeout);
9352 
9353 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */
9354 
9355 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */
9356 
9357 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...)		\
9358 	dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9359 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9360 	dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9361 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9362 	dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9363 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9364 	dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9365 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9366 	dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9367 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9368 	dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9369 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9370 	dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9371 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9372 	dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9373 #define wiphy_info_once(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9374 	dev_info_once(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9375 
9376 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
9377 	dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9378 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
9379 	dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9380 
9381 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9382 	wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args)
9383 
9384 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9385 	dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9386 
9387 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG)
9388 #define wiphy_vdbg	wiphy_dbg
9389 #else
9390 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...)				\
9391 ({									\
9392 	if (0)								\
9393 		wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args);	\
9394 	0;								\
9395 })
9396 #endif
9397 
9398 /*
9399  * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference
9400  * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the
9401  * file/line information and a backtrace.
9402  */
9403 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9404 	WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args);
9405 
9406 /**
9407  * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space
9408  * @netdev: network device
9409  * @owe_info: peer's owe info
9410  * @gfp: allocation flags
9411  */
9412 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev,
9413 				    struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info,
9414 				    gfp_t gfp);
9415 
9416 /**
9417  * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries
9418  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9419  */
9420 void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9421 
9422 /**
9423  * cfg80211_bss_color_notify - notify about bss color event
9424  * @dev: network device
9425  * @cmd: the actual event we want to notify
9426  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
9427  * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
9428  *
9429  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9430  */
9431 int cfg80211_bss_color_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9432 			      enum nl80211_commands cmd, u8 count,
9433 			      u64 color_bitmap);
9434 
9435 /**
9436  * cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify about bss color collision
9437  * @dev: network device
9438  * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
9439  *
9440  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9441  */
9442 static inline int cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9443 						       u64 color_bitmap)
9444 {
9445 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION,
9446 					 0, color_bitmap);
9447 }
9448 
9449 /**
9450  * cfg80211_color_change_started_notify - notify color change start
9451  * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
9452  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
9453  *
9454  * Inform the userspace about the color change that has started.
9455  *
9456  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9457  */
9458 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9459 						       u8 count)
9460 {
9461 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED,
9462 					 count, 0);
9463 }
9464 
9465 /**
9466  * cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify - notify color change abort
9467  * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
9468  *
9469  * Inform the userspace about the color change that has aborted.
9470  *
9471  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9472  */
9473 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device *dev)
9474 {
9475 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED,
9476 					 0, 0);
9477 }
9478 
9479 /**
9480  * cfg80211_color_change_notify - notify color change completion
9481  * @dev: the device on which the color was switched
9482  *
9483  * Inform the userspace about the color change that has completed.
9484  *
9485  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9486  */
9487 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device *dev)
9488 {
9489 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev,
9490 					 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED,
9491 					 0, 0);
9492 }
9493 
9494 /**
9495  * cfg80211_links_removed - Notify about removed STA MLD setup links.
9496  * @dev: network device.
9497  * @link_mask: BIT mask of removed STA MLD setup link IDs.
9498  *
9499  * Inform cfg80211 and the userspace about removed STA MLD setup links due to
9500  * AP MLD removing the corresponding affiliated APs with Multi-Link
9501  * reconfiguration. Note that it's not valid to remove all links, in this
9502  * case disconnect instead.
9503  * Also note that the wdev mutex must be held.
9504  */
9505 void cfg80211_links_removed(struct net_device *dev, u16 link_mask);
9506 
9507 /**
9508  * cfg80211_schedule_channels_check - schedule regulatory check if needed
9509  * @wdev: the wireless device to check
9510  *
9511  * In case the device supports NO_IR or DFS relaxations, schedule regulatory
9512  * channels check, as previous concurrent operation conditions may not
9513  * hold anymore.
9514  */
9515 void cfg80211_schedule_channels_check(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
9516 
9517 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_DEBUGFS
9518 /**
9519  * wiphy_locked_debugfs_read - do a locked read in debugfs
9520  * @wiphy: the wiphy to use
9521  * @file: the file being read
9522  * @buf: the buffer to fill and then read from
9523  * @bufsize: size of the buffer
9524  * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy to
9525  * @count: read count
9526  * @ppos: read position
9527  * @handler: the read handler to call (under wiphy lock)
9528  * @data: additional data to pass to the read handler
9529  *
9530  * Return: the number of characters read, or a negative errno
9531  */
9532 ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_read(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file,
9533 				  char *buf, size_t bufsize,
9534 				  char __user *userbuf, size_t count,
9535 				  loff_t *ppos,
9536 				  ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9537 						     struct file *file,
9538 						     char *buf,
9539 						     size_t bufsize,
9540 						     void *data),
9541 				  void *data);
9542 
9543 /**
9544  * wiphy_locked_debugfs_write - do a locked write in debugfs
9545  * @wiphy: the wiphy to use
9546  * @file: the file being written to
9547  * @buf: the buffer to copy the user data to
9548  * @bufsize: size of the buffer
9549  * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy from
9550  * @count: read count
9551  * @handler: the write handler to call (under wiphy lock)
9552  * @data: additional data to pass to the write handler
9553  *
9554  * Return: the number of characters written, or a negative errno
9555  */
9556 ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_write(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file,
9557 				   char *buf, size_t bufsize,
9558 				   const char __user *userbuf, size_t count,
9559 				   ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9560 						      struct file *file,
9561 						      char *buf,
9562 						      size_t count,
9563 						      void *data),
9564 				   void *data);
9565 #endif
9566 
9567 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */
9568